Professional Documents
Culture Documents
l
ria
lntroduction
a Inside this
1.1. Background
1.2. Development
chapter
ate
1.3. Specification of Requirement
1.4. Man Instrumentation
yM
1.5. Problems Encountered in Measuring
a Living System
1.6. Anatomy and physiological
1.7. Summary
BACKGROUND
The prefix bio, means something connected
engineering. Biophysics and biochJmistry
with rife in biomedical
interdisciplines basic sciences
have been applied to living things. Similarly,
Bio-instrumentation means
measurement of biological variables, Trre
ud
l
Instrumentation (AAMI) consists of both engineers and physicians. A
clinical engineer is a professional who brings to health care facilities a
ria
level of education, experience, and accomplishment which will enable
him to responsibly, effectively, and safely manage and interface with
medical devices, instruments, and systems and the use thereof during
patient care, and who can, because of this level of competence,
responsibility and directly serve the patient and physician, nurse, and
other health care professional, relative to their use of and other contact
with medical instrumentation. Most clinical engineers go into profession
through the engineering degree route, but some may start out as
ate
physicists.
Some of the instruments like electrocardiograph were first used by
the end of nineteenth centuiy. But the progress was slow until the end
of World War-II. After the war lot of electronic equipments such as
amplifiers and recorders became available. Many technicians and
engineers started to experiment with and modified existing equipment
for medical use. The result of development did not yield good result
dueto the lack of unders-tanding of physical parameters and
communication problem with the medical professionals.
yM
DEVELOPMENT
During 1951-60, many instrument manufacturers entered the field
of medical instrumentation. But development was slow due to high costs
of development. The hospital staffs was reluctant to use new equipment.
Many times, the medical staff was uncooperative. In view of this, some
progressive companies decided to design instrumentation specifically for
medical use instead of modifying the existing hardware.
Help was provided by the US government, in particular by NASA. A
large number of physiological parameters needed to be monitored for the
astronauts. Hence, aerospace medicine programmes were expanded
ud
quite different from those of the engineer. The physician must understand
enough engineering terminologr for him to discuss problems with the
engineer. The burden of bridging the communication gap falls on the
engineer. The result is that the engineer, must learn the doctor's language,
as well as some anatomy and physiologr, in order that the two disciplines
can work effectively together.
Page No. 2 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation \
lntroduction 3
REQUIREMENT
Any instrumentation system generally should achieve one of the
following major categories for meeting the basic objective.
l
1. Information gathering : Instrumentation is used to measure natural
ria
phenomena and other variables to aid man in his search for
knowledge about himself and the universe in which he lives.
2. Diagnosis : For the detection and, hopefully, the correction of some
incorrect behaviour of the system being measured the measuremens
are made. This type of instrumentation may be classified as
"troubleshooting equipment,,.
3. Evaluation : Measurements hetp to determine the ability of a system
ate
to meet its' functional requirements. These could be classihed as
"proof of performance" or ,,quality control,, tests.
4. Monitoring : Instrumentation helps in monitoring some process or
operation in order to obtain continuous or periodic information
about the state of the system being measured.
5. control : Instrumentation may help control of the operation of a
system based on changes in one or more of the internal parameters
or in the output of the system.
yM
Biomedical instrumentation involves all the objectives of the general
instrumentation system. Instrumentation for biomedical research can
generally be considered as information gathering instrumentation. It
also includes some monitoring and control devices. Instrumentation helps
the physician in the diagnosis of disease and other disorders also has
widespread use. Instrumentation is arso used in evaluation of the physical
condition of patients in routine physical examination. Special
instrumentation system, are used for monitoring of patients undeigoing
surgery or are kept in intensive care.
Biomedical instrumentation can generally be divided into following
types:
ud
1. Clinical instrumentation
2. Research instrumentation
clinical instrumentation is basicarly used for the diagnosis, care and
treatment of patients. But research instrumentation is used for acquiring
new knowledge pertaining to the various systems that compose the human
organism. Although some instruments can be used in both areas.
clinical instruments are more rugged and easiar to use. The main
St
l
living orJanism itself. An example would be a device irrserted into the
blood stream to measurc pH of the blood directly. An in vitro
ria
measurement is one which is performed outside the body, even though
it relates to the function of the body. In vitro rneans "in glass" i.e.,
the measurements are to be performed in test tubes. The man-
instrument system dealt in this book applies mainly to in vivo
measLlrements. However, obtaining appropriate samples for in vitro
measLlrements and in relating these measurements to the living human
being is problematic.
ate
1.4. MAN INSTRUMENTATION SYSTEM
Biomedical instrumentation is a set of instruments and equipment utilized
in t1-re measurement of one or more characteristics or phenomena, and
the presentatjon of information obtained from those measurements in a
forrl that can be read and interpreted by man. This is the definition of
instrument from the complete man-instrument system v,-hich must also
include the human or: subject on whom the measurement are being
macle.
yM
Due to special pi:oblems faced in getting data from living organism,
specialll, hr-tman beings, and because of the large amount of interaction
between 1he instrumentation system and the subject being measured, it
is necessary that the person on whom the measurements are being
made be considered an integral part of the instnrmentation sYstem. In
order to make sense out of the data obtained from the black box the
humans organism) the internai characteristic of the black box must be
considered in the design and application of any instruments. The overall
svstem, which includes both the organism and the instrumentation
required for measurement of the human is called the man-instrument
system.
ud
whom the measurements are being made. It should not cause undue
pain, discomfort. This means that many of the measurement techniques
normally employed in the instrumentation of nonliving systems cannot
be applied in the instrumentation of huuans.
Man instrumentation system involves the measurement of outputs
from an unkno-rvn s-vstem as they are affected by various combinations
Page No. 4 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation \
lntroduction 5
of inputs. The requirement is to understand the nature and
characteristics of the system. The unknown system is referred as a
black box. It has a variety of configurations for a given combination of
inputs and outputs. The end product of such an exercise is a set of
l
input-output equations for the internal functions of the black box.
ria
These functions may be simple or extremery complex. The living human
being is one of the most complex black boxes. This black box consists
of electrical, mechanical, acoustical, thermal, chemical, optical,
hydraulic, pneumatic and many other types of systems. These systems
may interact with each other. The human being here referred to as
black box may also contain a powerful computer, severar types of
communication systems, and a great variety of control systems. However,
living black box gives risc to other probrems. Many of the important
ate
variables to be measured are not readily accessible to measuring devices.
The measuring device itself introduces some error.
Some other some problems in obtaining correct measurements are
(1) Safety considerations, (2) the environment of the hospital in which
these measurements are performed (3) the medical personnel usually
involved in the measurements and (4) sometimes even ethical and legal
considerations.
Basic principle of biomedical instrumentation is shown in figure 1. 1
block diagram. Here, any phiological event becomes input of a
yM
transducer. Transducer gives transduced electrical signal which is
subjected to signal conditioning. Subsequentity, the output signal is
displayed and or saved.
ud
Speeking
l
ria
Behaving
Sm ng
Looks
Exhailing
lnhaling
Movement
ate
Sensation ot Body
due to touching
lntake of Liquid
lntake of Food
Liquid in
Waste form
yM
Solid in
waste form
Transducer-1
Body Temperature
Signal
Conditi-
onrng
Device
St
Transducer-4
Body muscles
Data processing, recording
and transmission
lntroduction 7
1.4.1. Subject
The human being on whom the measurements are made is knor,vn
as subject. The subject who makes this system different from
other instrumentation systems are treated in much greater cletaii in
l
section 1.5.
ria
1.4.2. Stimulus
The response to some form of external stimulus is required. The
instrumentation used to generate and present this stiinulus to the subject
is an essential part of the man-instrument system whenever responses
are measured. Visual (e.g. a flash of light), auditory (e.g., a tone) tactile,
or direct electrical stimulation of some part of the nervous system of any
subject.
ate
1.4.3. Transducer
A transducer is defined as a device capabie of converting one form
of energ,' or signai to another. In the man-instrument system, each
transducer is used to produce an electric signal. It is in the form of
analog signal of the phenomenon being measured. The transducer may
measure temperature, pressure flow or any of the other variables that
can be found in the body, but its output is always an electrical signal.
As shown in figure 1.3, two or more transducers may be used
simultaneously to obtain relative variations between phenomena, the
yM
example shows four transducers.
1.4.4. Signal-Conditioning Equipment
The instrumentation system part which amplifies, modifies, or in any
other way changes the electric output of the transducer is called signal
conditioning equipment. The purpose of signal conditioning or signal
processing equipment is to process the signals from the transducers in
order to satisfy the functions of the system and to prepare signals
suitable for operating the display or recording equipment.
1.4.5. Display Equipment
The output of the signal conditioning equipment must be converted
ud
l
1.4.7 . Control Devices
ria
It it is necessary to have automati
instrument sYstem'
PROBLEMS ENCOUNT
ate
and physiological systern of the btdy.d",*11P^"
T:3,T*:ilT'Jlffi'"T.1t1":i';:ffi'#;i;;;;il"'^c'i"k"ltl:;
measurement on a human subJect'
t.or rllca'-ururrrvrrL rre'
measuremellt
..rpments are done on animal su 'jects' The
some measurements
below
problems are summ arized as given
:
parts of that
stimulation of one part of a given system affects all other
as weil'
system in some *ay and oftEn affects other systems
1.5.5. Effect of the Transducer on the Measurement
by the presence
l
Any kind of measurement is affe
complex in the-
of the measuring transducer' The
ria
sical presence of
measurement of living systems' In m
the transducer changes the reading significantly'
1.5.6. Artifacts
The term ar s a signal that is extlaneous
to the variable e ajor source of artifacts in
the measuring g ment of the subject'
ate
1.5.7. EnergY Limitation
Some physiological measurement techniques
require that a certain
amount of energr ie applitd -to the living system in order to obtain a
measurement.Forexampleresistance-",...,.".entrequiretheflowof
measured'
electric current ttrrough the tissues or blood being
1.5.8. SafetY Gonsiderations
being subjected to
There should be no danger to the life of the living
must be taken in the design
rneasuring variables. Extra caution must be
yM
ofanymeasulementsystemtoprotectthepatient.similarlythe
cause undue paiir'
-.."r.i..-ent should not
1.6. ANATOMY AND PHYSIOLOGICAL
being' it is necessary
In order to obtain valicl measurements from a iiving
of the subject on which the-measurements
to have some
are being m e human body one can find electrical'
mechanical, t lic, pneumatic' chernical and various other
types of sys which communicates with an external
environrnent. with the other systems of the bodl'' These
complex functions by
individual systems are orgamzed to perform many
ud
network' The
means of a multilevel control system and communication
va
integrated operation of all these sy
heip to srrstain 1ife. learn to perfo
ac
be yzed
environment. These inputs ancl outpu but
in a variety of ways. Most are r sibl
are and
some like speech, behavior ancl
interpret needing special -technologres'
Electro-encephalogram
(Nervous system) Electro-occulogram
l
(Occular system)
ria
Bespiratory
Esophagus Temperature Parameter
Pulmanary system
lmpedence
Pneumography
(lungs) Blood Pressure
Phonocardiogram (Cardiovascular system)
(heart sound)
Electrocardiogram
(Heart)
Pulse-Rate
Cardiovascular system
ate Electromyogram
(muscular system)
Blood Flow
(cardiovascular
system)
yM
ud
St
lntroduction 11
l
then the functions of the mind and body of man could be clearly
understood and could be completely defined by pr-esently known laws of
ria
physics, chemistry and other sciences. The difficulty is that many of the
inputs are not accessible for measurement. The interrelationships among
elements are sometimes very complex ancl involve so many systems that
the 'laws' and relationships thus clerived are inadequate to define them
completely. Thus the mathematicai models in use toclay contain so many
assumptions and constraints that their application is often limited.
A brief engineering oriented description of the major physioJogical
ate
systems oft the body are given below:
1.6.1. Biochemical System
An integrated unit of chemical systems that produce eners/ for the
actirzity of the body, messenger agents for communication materials for
body repair and growth, and substances required to carry out the various
body functions are within the body. A11 operations of this highly efficient
chemical factory are managed by a single point of intake tor ruet (food),
water and air, all the source materials for numerous chemical reactions
are produced with in the body. The body contains all the monitoring
yM
equipment needed to provide the degree of control necessary for each
chemical operation and it also has an efficient waste disposal system
similar to a chemical factory.
1 .6.2. Cardiovascullar System
Figure 1.5 shows a cardiovascurar system and figures 1.6 (a) and (b)
show alatomy of heart and a cutview of heart respectively. Cardiovascular
system can be considered as a complex and closecl hydraulic system with
four-chamber pump the heart connected to flexible elastic tubing blood
vessels. The arteries and arterioles tubing changes its diameter to control
pressure. Reservoirs in the veins changes their volume and characteristics
to satis$r certain control requirements, ancl a system of gates and variable
ud
l
ria
:ubcla.Jian L*lt pr,t}l,tion*tY
"*,\ ' ai'le i!'
L.*ii pi.tltttonai'Y v*ti:s
$eplur: I
'f
irici.r*i'i fi:ratietr ovaie
ate
i116rial! vat$ faiiii la. ,1.,1 i! I O, til e
t()rx lslt ventricls
1-* pi;imli.l+.rY
, critire lr*m
riSht v*ritricie
Coeirac aiL{:ry
Sui:erior
11:esentaftc
prlery
{rirena-.1
yM
lJuciili
vanoSils
r!l ir:r.r
_'\i'i.i,'
ri'-^r'.,
ulmbilict-is
ud
fluid. The f1uid. aiso contains mechanism for repairing small system
punctui:es, i.e., arrd. for rejecting foreign elements from the system' i'e"
plrt.t"t" and white blood cells, respectively. Sensors provided to detect
in the need, for supplies, and built up of waste materials' and
"h"ng""
out of tolerance pressures in the system are known as chemoreceptors,
P"o, senSors and baroreceptors, respectively' These and other mechanisms
Page No. 12 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation \
lntrociuction 13
control the pump's speed and efficienc;r, the blood flow pattern through
the system, tubing diameters, and clther factors. Rs pait of the system
works against gravity, special one-way varves are piovided to pievent
gravity from pulling blood against the direction of flow between pump
l
c5zcles. The variables of prime importance in this system are the pr-p,
i.e., cardiac output and the pressure, flow rate and volume of blood at
ria
various locations throughout the candiovascular system.
To head
To right arm
To left arm
Aortic arch to body
ate
Superior vena cava Pulmonary vein
- Left atrium
Valve
Valve *****'***
lnferior vena
Left ventricle
yM
cava from body
Bight ventricle
right atrio /
St
l
diaphragm, which alternatively creates negative
ln a sealecl chamber, i.e., tltotacic cavity, be suc
ria
the forced out of a pair of elastic bags, i' ated wi
compartment. The bags are connected to the onment
n p."".g"*ay, i.e., nlsal cavities; pharynx, larynx' trachea' bronchi and
bronchioles,whichatonepointisC)mmonwiththetubirrgthatcarries pnematic
liquids and solids to the stomach. A speciai value interrupts the
;;'."i"- whenever liquid or solid matter passes through the common
region. The passageway divides to carry air into each of
the bags' wherein
des m carry ai out f the
ate
air sP ary alve the duel
nasal an alter i'e', h for
for other special purposes' In the
use in the event of nasal blockage and
tinyairSpacesofthebagsisamembraneinterfacewiththebody,s is
hydraulic system through which certain gases can diffuse' Oxygen is
air' and carbon dioxide
taken into the blood fiom the incoming
transferred from the fluid to the air, which is exhausted
by the force of
with a two way override' An
the pneumatic pump. The pump operates
automatic control center, i.L', respiratory center of the brain maintains
rlu is aclequats n and carry
yM
the sYstem. s of Primary
off tory volume
im resPiratory
exPrred air' ativelY fixed
an
volurnesandcapacitiessuchastidalvolurnethevolumeinspiredor
expired during each normal breath, inspiratory reserve volume
the
additional volume that can be inspired after a normal inspiration'
expiratory reserve volume the additlonal amount of air
that can be
forcedoutofthelungsafternormalexpiration,residualvolume(amount
ofairremainingint-helungsafternormalexpiration)residrralvolurne,
i.e., amount of air remainin"g in the lungs after all possibie
air has been
plus inspiratory reserve
forced out and vital capacity, i.e., tidal volume,
ud
eventually take
certain section is damaged, other sections can adapt and
over at least in part thJ function of the damagecl section ' By r-lse of the
brainapersonisabletomakedecisions,solvecomplexproblems'create I
art, poeiry, music, "feel" e informat
Produce I
parts of tire body, anC coo
nication t
tehaviour. The brain has
bringsSensoryinformati.onintoancltransmitcontrolinformationoutof
Page No. 14 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
lntroduction 15
the brain. In general, these lines are not single long lines but often
complicated networks with many interconnections that are continually
changing to meet the needs of the system. By means of the interconnection
patterns, signals from a large number of sensory devices, which detect
l
light, sound, pressure, heat, cold and certain chemicals are connected
to the appropriate parts of the computer, where they can be acted upon.
ria
Similarly, output control signals are directed to specific motor units of
the muscles which respond to the signals with some type of motion or
force. Feedback regarding every action controlled by the system is provided
to the brain through appropriate sensors. Information is coded in the
system by rneans of electrochemical pulses nerve action potentials that
travel along the signal nerves. The pulses can be transferred from one
element of a network to another in one direction only, and frequently the
ate
trensfer takes place only when there is the proper combination of elements
acting on the next element in the chain. Both serial and parallel coding
are used sometimes together in the same direction. In addition to the
central computer, a large number of simple decision-making devices
spinal reflexes are present to control directly certain motor devices from
some sensory inputs. A number of feedback loops are formed by this
method. A11 the important decision making is performed by the brain.
yM
Age of Biomedical Engineering: In I974, a society in the name of
Association for the Advancement of Medical Instrumentation (AAMI)
was formed. It gave the following definition of the clinical engineer.
'A clinical engineer is a professional who brings to health care facilities
a level of education, experience, and accomplishment which will enable
him to responsibly, effectively, and safely manage and interface with
medical devices, instruments, and systems and the use thereof during
patient care, and who can, because of this level of competence,
responsibility and directly serve the patient and physician, nurse,
and other health care professional, relative to their use of and other
contact with medical instrumentation."
Development of Biomedical Instrumentation: The development of
ud
2.
bio-medical engineering started just after \Alorld War II. With the
availability of discarded electronic circuits like amplifier, oscillators,
etc. and availability of skilled manpower due to recession. The real
:S development started when NASA was launched.
te The living human being is considered as a black box. This black box
v consists of electrical, mechanical, thermal, chemical and other type
a of systems. The function of medical instrumentation is to aid the
St
(lii) Evaluation
(iu) Monitoring
(u) Control
Ja Specification of Requirement : Instrumentation for biomedical
l
research can generally be vier,ved as information gathering
instrumentation. Although it sometimes includes some monitoring
ria
and control devices.
Biomedical instmmentation can generally be classified into following
categorles:
1. Clinical instrumentation
2. Research instrumentation
Clinical instr-umentation is bascially used for diagnosis and are rugged
in nature. The research instrumentation is normally more complex,
ate
more specialised and designed to provide a much higher degree of
accuracy, resolution.
Measurement in biomedical instrumentation can be further subdivided
into two categories in vivo and in vitro. An in vivo measurement is
made within the living organism. While the invitro measurement is
one which is performed outside the body and normally in the test
tube.
Man Instrument System: The block diagram of the man
instrumentation system can be seen in figure 1.3. The major aspect
is the inclusion of human being u.hich is named as a subject.
yM
Phisological events of human body give signals to suitable transducer.
Electrical output of transducer is passed though signal conditioning.
Subsequently, the output can be recor:ded or displayed. The stimuls
given to the subject may be in the form of visual, auditory or an
electrical impulse.
5 Problems Encountered in Measuring a Living System: The following
problems are encountered, to measure parameters correctly in a
living system.
(a) Inaccessibility of variables to measurement.
(b) Variability of the Data.
ud
lntroduction 17
l
(b) Cctrdiouascular system: Tl:'e caridodvascular system can be
explained as a complex closed hydraulic s).stem with four Chamber
ria
pump (heart) connected the blood vessels, ateries and arterioles.
the tubing changes its diameter to control pressure. It works as
a synchronised pump in which the first stage of each pump
(atrium) collects the blood from the system and pumps it into the
second stage (ventricle). The action of second stage is so timed
that the fluid is pumped into the system immediately after receiving
it from the hrst stage. Then the right side of the heart (atrium)
is to collects the fluid from the main hydraulic system and pump
ate
it through lungs for oxygenation. The other pump (left side of the
heart) received the oxygenated blood and pumps it into the main
hydraulic system to all the organs.
(c) Respiratory system is a pneumatic system where the oxygen is
inspired in the elastic bags (lungs). The lungs are connected to
outside world by nasal cavities, pharynix, larynx, trachea. The
lungs oxygenate the blood and take out carbon dioxide, which
is expired to the outside world.
la) Neruous system: The nervous system or brain just works like a
yM
computer. Its centre is a self adapting central information system
with memory, computational power, decision making capabilities
any many input output channel. The information is generally
coded in the system by means of electrochemical pulses that
travel along the nerves. Both serial and parallel coding are used
sometime in the same direction. A number of feedback loops are
formed.
txerciaea
1.1. Explain the various components of physiological system of body.
ud
(UPTU-2004\
7.2 Explain the difference between measurement in physiological system and
physical system. (UPTU'MQPI\
1a
l -.)_ Discuss the various objectives of a medical instrumentation system.
(UPTU-2OOs\
1,.4. What are the various problems encountered in measuring a living system?
Explain ARTIFACTS (LIPTU-2003\
1.5. Explain the difference between the in vivo and in vitro measurement.
St
(UPTU-MQPs)
),.6. Discuss biomedical instrumentation types nameiy for clinical and research
purposes. How they differ from each other?
AJJ
Page No. 17 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
Bioelectric Potentials
INTRODUCTION
Human cells are too small in size. They can be seen only through a
microscope. Each cell has generally one nucleous and an outer plasma
membrane. Figure 2.1. (al shows a cell in magnihed form which depits
ud
important elements.
Various signals are generated by human body in the process of
carrying out various functions. These generated signals are bioelectric
potentials which relate with nerves muscular activity, heart beat, etc.
Bioelectric potentials are consequence of chemical changes in the
associated cells.
The muscle cells can be excited chemically, and mechamically to
produce an action potential that is transmitted along their cell membrane.
St
Bioelectric Potentials 1g
nervous stimulation lacks anotomic
l
ria
spontancoeusly.
Smooth muscre racks cross-striations.
The type found in most hoilow
al and contains pacemakers that discharge
the eye and in some other locations is not
embles skeletal muscle.
Rough endoplsamic
ate
reticulum (RER)
Lysosome
Cytoplasm
Vacuole
Centrosome
Smooth endoplasmic
reticulum (SEB)
3j"',::l_:'?::^"^o^Tj-","^"9
certain
result
l:
" as :f
special type of ce ls are known
,!.
electrochemical activity or
bioelecrri" pot..rtiuf ;;#ffiJ.:i
3:H.*::":::,"'l_,:it",o-1,:-1,,?rsinto..erect,i""r;i#:;,#";ffii:
i terpreted ,""r,,ny i, ;;;;;?r ;;;;" ;i".l1i:
:?::::i:"j:1.1lg
physician in diagnosis and rreatment ,i
o, generate";ri;;";ilil:
o their own monitoring si gnal s
:.::i::, :r_"::.T:,,^1_,1various
II firnctions. rhese signals
.d. ;;;:=, #il1
St
permits some substance to pass through while others are not permitted.
This has been established through experiments'
The ions inside the membrane are called Intetnal Cell Flui.d arrd
the ions outside the membrane calied External cell Fluid as shown in
l
figure 2.r lb).
ria
External
Cell Fluid
lnternal
Cell Fluid
K'
ate
Semi permeable
Membrane
Na*
Fig. 2.1. (b) Semipermeable membrane
Whenthesemipermeablemembraneisinnorrnalcondition,the
sodium ions (Na*) remains outside the membrane. In the normal condition,
the sodium (Na;) ions cannot pass through the membrane. However,
permeability of
fotassium (K*) ions can pass through the membrane as (Na*) ions'
iotassium iX*l iorr" is too high as compared to sodium
If the membrane is stimulated or excited, the characteristics of
in
yM
nrembrane changes, therefore, the sodium ions can enter as shown
f,rgure 2.2. once the membrane is stimulated, all the sodium
ions can
eiter the membrane. At the same time, potassium (K*) ion try to leave
the cell. The distribution of ions is as follows:
Ions lnternal Extetnal
Cell Fluid lons Cell Fluid lons
Na* 60 110
K* t20 20
c1- 45 100
ud
St
Na*
Fig. 2.2. Stimulated Semipermeable Membrane
The bioelectric signals produced in human body are due to coordinated
activity of the large grouP of excitable cells. The amplitude and frequency
range of such bioelectric signals are as follows:
Page No. 20 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation ,\
Bioelectric Potentials 21
l
Heart 50 pV-5 pV 0.05-100 Hz ECG
Brain 2 pV-100 pV 1-100 Hz
ria
EtrG
Muscle 20 pV-5 pV 10 Hz-2 kHz EMG
ate
a semipermeable membrane whjch allow some substalces to pass-through
the membrane whereas others are not allowed to pass through.
we also know that thes-e cells of the body are surrounded by body
fluids which are conductive solutions containing charge atoms, i.e., ions.
t
The prominent ions are sodium (Na+), potassium (K*), and chloride (c1).
The membrane of the cells allow entry of potassium and chloride ions
t
f whereas blocks the entry of sodium ions. various ions seek a balance
between the inside of the cell and the outside . The sodium is unable to
penetrate the. membra.ne. This results in unbalance of ions concentration
f
and electric charge. The concentration of sodium ions inside the cell
yM
1
becomes much iower than in the intercellular fluid outside. The sodium
1
e
ions are positive, therefore, this makes the outside of the cell more
positive than the inside. In an attempt to balance the electric charge, the
additional potassium ions vrhich are positive, enter the cell, .
"^r"irlg
higher concentration of potassium on the inside than on the outside (see
figr,rre 2.3(al)
ud
K*
St
Fig. 2.3. (a) Nerve and muscle cells are encased in a semipermeable membrane
Sodium ions (Na*) are unable to penetrate
l
ria
-60to-100mV
ate
Fig. 2.3. (b) A polarized with its resting potential
Na*
+20 mV
St
Bioelectric Potentials 23
l
but are unable to out that fast. The net result is slightly higher potential
ria
inside the cell. This potential is known as th action potential which can
be about + 20 rnY.In other words, cell which is excited gets depolarized
and leads to action potential. The process of changing from resting state
to action potential is called depolarization. The figure 2 a@) and 2.4(b)
illustrate depolarization and depolarized state Action Potential respectively.
2.3.3. Waveform of an Action Potential
Depolarization
;-20
c
:_30
ate
yM
6
E
E -40
E
o-
-50
After potentials
-90
t (milliseconds)
ud
000436
Contraction
Potential
St
When the rush of sodium ions through the cell membrane stops'
a
new state of equilibrium is reached and the ionic currents that le-rwered
lhe barometer to sodium ions are nor present; the rnembrarre beharves
in its normal conditiorr i.e., sodium ions are not allowed to enterquickly inside
l
from outside. At this stage of the process, sodium ions are process
ria
tr.ansported from inside of cell to outside of cell and this
active
is known as sodium pump. Once all sodium ions are pumped outside the
fiom
cell, the cell reaches its Resting Potential. The process of change
very
Action Potential to Resting Potential is known as Repolarization'
little is known about the reason of sodium puirlp, but it can be though
to be balancing effect after ionic currents are renoved'
The time
The waveform of the action potential is shown in figure 2.5"
scale depends on the type of cell prorlucing the poiential Nene and
ate
,*'hereas heart muscle duration
muscle -ry have 1 m sec duration, com-
as high as 3OO m sec. Please note that after repolarization
may be ".11"
pletion, resting potential is named "after potentials", which reaches restinl'
potential slowlY.
onceacellisexcitedandgeneratedactionpotential,ioniccurrents
begin to flow. This process excites neighbo cells o
with a lotrg -ring
f,rber may h
areas of the same cell. A nerve cell
yM
potential over a small segment of the fiber, but it is propagated in both
an action
directions from the origin"point of excitation. The rate at which
potential moves down a fiber or is P
propagation rate. In nerve cells the
l4O meters Per second. The ProP
slower in the range of O.2 to 0'4 m
as low as
of the heart have special cells which have propagation rate of
0.05 meter Per second.
The propagation cf action potential is explained further rvith
the help
of figure 2.6.
Local Closeci (solenoidal)
ud
++++ ++++++
+++
Active region
+++71++
Bioelectric Potentials 25
l
is remaining only for short duration of time. After depolarization, the
ria
membrane repolarizes completely. 1'his is the way the action potential
propagates along the length of the fiber.
The myeiin sheath is interrupted at reguiar intervals by nocles known
as nodes of refiner in the case of myeiinated nerve f,rber as shown in
lrgure 2.v. Tlne sheath increases the impedances to the current flow. The
sodium ions channel have non-uniform distribution. The density is more
at the nocies.
ate
Active Myelin
Node Sheath
Periaxonal --J
Space
loo1
ud
1 02 5101520
Time (msec)-------+ Time (msec)
-9'"
Fig. 2.8. Action potentials muscle of nerves and muscle
St
.l-
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
26 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
ions. The lateral components of triads release calcium ions which liberates
a substance in the muscle which subsequently activates the adenosine
triphosphatase activity of Myosyn. Nerve hbre generated action potential
can be recorded as per figure 2.9.
l
ria
Axon
Recording
Micro Pipet
Electronic
Microelectrode
Simulator
Amplifier
vo
ate
lndifferent
Electrode
Potential I
Resting
when the tip of the micropipet is inserted through the membrane, the
movement artifact is generated. Recording is done for resting potential. The
recording is done instantaneously as the stimulus artifacts r,,",hen stimulus
is applied. The action potential travels along the nerve at a constant speed.
The latent period I is recorded as the time taken for the tralsmission of the
potential from stimulating point to the recording point.
St
Bioelectric Potentials 27
l
are named on the application basis such as ECG (electrocardiogram),
EEG (electroencephalogram), EMG (electromyogram), etc.
ria
2.5.1. Electrocardiogram (ECG)
ECG are the biopotentials generated by the muscles of the heart.
This is also known as EKG (electrokardiogram in German). The action
potential in the heart originates near the top of the right Atrium at a
point called the pacemaker or sinoatrial (sA) node. The pacemakers are
a group of specialized cells that spontaneously generates action potentials
at a regular rate which are controlled by "innervation". The heart beat
ate
is the result of the action potentials generated by pacemakers which
propagate in all directions along the surface of both atria. Recorded ECG
waveforms are is shown in the figure 2.lI (a\.
yM
ud
St
l
ria
ate
Fi1.2.11. (b) An ECG waveform
The normal ECG has- PQRS characteristics as shown in the figure
2.ll (bl for the chest leads which are scaled. P wave is known as base
line which represents depolarization of the arterial musculator QRS
represents the repolarization of arteria and depolarization of ventricles
which occur almost simultaneously. The Twave represents repolarization
of both ventricles. U wave is the result of after potentials in ventricular
muscle. The slope and polarity of each feature varies with the location
of measuring electrodes with respect to the heart. A normal ECG patten
yM
is quantified in the figure 2.12.
R=5mV
P(<0.25 mV)
ud
0.05-1
| 0.12-0.2 I OT Duration I I
St
Bioelectric Potentials 29
l
be left Ventricular, Left Artrial, Right Ventricular or Right Atrial. The
ria
metabolic effects lnay lead to electrolyte abnormalities, wrong medication
or thyroid disease.
2.5.2. Electroencephalogram (EEG)
The bioelectric potentiais generated by the neuronal activity of the
brain is called the EEG. The EEG waveform is very complex and more
difhcult to recognize than the ECG. A sample of the EEG is shown in
the figure 2.13. The electrodes are located on the surface of the scalp.
ate
(a)Awake and alert EEG Frequency
yM
(b) Deep Sleep EEG Frequency
Fig. 2"13. Human EEG for different stages
It may be noted that awake and alert signal frequency is very high
as compared to deep sleep EEG frequency.
Rhythmical potentials are generated by brain. These potential originate
from individual neurons of the brain. The waveform pattern is complex
is terrned electro-encephalogram (EEG). The rnillions of the cells discharge
synchronously and get summed up for the net generated potential.
The neuons are electrically polarized at rest similar to other cells.
ud
The neuron has potential of -70 mV with respect to the exterior. When
a neuron is subjected to a stimulus (above threshold), a nerve impulse
due to change in membrane potential is generated which spreads in the
cell. This depolarizes the cell and shortly afterwards repolarization takes
place.
The signal of EEG are taken from electrodes either from scalp or
directly from the cerebral cortex. The peak to peak amplitude is 100 mV
St
Beta
-13H2-22H2
Gamma 22Hz-30Hz
Alpha rhythm indicates alertness of the brain which sen'es as indicator
of anesthesia in the operating room. The waveforms can be summarized
l
as follows:
ria
Waveform Frequency Occurence
ate
Beta waves 13 - 30 Hz Normal
interest or directly from the muscle by penetrating the skin with needle
electrodes.
EMG signals may be measured at the surface of the body near a
muscle under study or from the muscle by penetrating the strain with
needle electrodes. The amount of muscle activity is indicated in the EMG
rneasurement, the action potential lasting only felv milliseconds. The
potential may range from 50 pv to 5 mV with a duration of 2lo 15 msec.
lfr. BVfC amplitude is the instantaneous sum of all action potentials
St
l
ria
Fig. 2.14. A typical EMG waveshape
ate
yM
Fig. 2.15. EMG recording arrangement
ud
Spind
Conductive
Lesion
Motor
Peripheral Neuron
Nerve Lesion lesion
Neuro Muscular
Synape Diseases Muscular
Diseases
St
l
audible on a loudspeaker.
The muscular "Paralysis" can be due to a lesion in the parts of the
ria
neryous system which supply to muscle. The figure 2.16 shows electrical
connection of the nervous system.
2.5.4. Electrogastrogram (EGG)
EGG signal has basically EMG pattern. It is associated with the
peristaltic movements of the gastrointestinal tract. When surface
electrodes are placed. on the abdomen over the stomach, the signal of the
ate
gastric myoelectrical activity is recorded which is electrogastrogram. But,
EGG is not enough to diagnose stomach diseases, therefore, it requires
additional informations.
2.5.5. Electro-oculograph (EOG)
when the bio-potential generated by the movement of the eyeball is
recorded, it is known as electro-oculograph. If a small electrode is put
on the skin near the eye, it gives EOG potentials. The signal of the
vertical movements of eyeball is piked up by placing one pair of electrodes
above and below the eye. similarly, the horizontal movement signal is
yM
picked up by placing another pair of electrode to the left and right of the
eye. EOG is hardly used for any clinical purpose.
2.5.6. Electroretinograph (ERG)
There is an electrical potential difference between the cornea and the
body of the eye. when the eye is illuminated, this potential changes. The
recording of this change of potential is known as electro retinograph
(ERG) . For this recording, one electrode is mounted on a contact lens
which is in direct contact with cornea and the other electrode is put on
the skin adjacent to the outer corner of the eye. If needed, a reference
electrod.e may be put on the forehead. The magnitude of the signal is
dependent on the intensity and the duration of the light falling on the
ud
Bioelectric Potentials 33
l
(a) Awake and alert response
ria
ate
response
from its origin to neighbouring cells. The nerve cells propagation rate
is 2O to 140 meters per second, whereas heart muscle cell propagation
rate is slower in the range from O.2 to 0.4 meters per second.
9 ECG: These are the bipotentials generated by the muscles of the
heart known as electrocardiogram.
l
12. EGG is the recording of the signal generated due to the gastric
ria
mvelectrical activity.
13. EOG is the recording of the signal generated due to the movement
of the eye ba11.
14. ERG rs the recording of the signal generated due to the illumination
of the eye.
15. Envoked Responses: These are EtrG signals in the various state of
humans such as being awake, light sleep, deep sleep, etc.
ate
C
(;IrClded
2.1. What do you understand by bioelectric potential and how is it useful?
2.2. How are the bioelectric potentials measured? Name some of the equipments
using such measurement.
2.3. What are the sources of bioelectric potentials and why are these present
in the body?
2.4. Explain Resting and Action Potentials. (UPTU-2003\
2.5. trxplain and draw diagrams for trCG, EtrG and EMG. (UPTU-2004)
yM
2.6. Draw an active potentiai waveform and level thq Amplitude and Time
values. (uPru-MQP4
2.7. Explain polarization, depolarization and repolarization. (UPTU-MQP2)
2.8. Explain propagation of active potential. (UPTU-2004\
2.9. What is EtrG? Why is it much more difficult to recognize than ECG? How
can certain characteristic EEG waveforms be related to sleep?
(UPTU-2004\
trtrtr
ud
St
l
ria
Transducers
a Inside this chdpter
3.1.
3.2.
3.3.
3.4.
3.5.
Introduction
Active Transducers
Passive Transducers
ate
Transducer and Transduction Principles
INTRODUCTION
Medical instruments are generally electronic devices, therefore, they require
an electrical signal as an input. A physical event of the body represents
a parameter which has a transducible property. This is transformed into
ud
i
-t
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
of the eiectrical output signal in the form of voltages, current frequency
or pulse width must be a nonambigrious function of the nonelectrical
ria
variables at the input. Ideally the relationship between input and output
should be linear. A linear relationship is not always possible, but the
reiationship between input and output should fo1low some rules like
logarithmic function or square 1aw. As long as the transduction function
is nonambiguous it is possible to detelmine the magnitude of the input
variable from the electrical output signal at least in principle. Certain
other variables may interface with the transduction process such as
hysteresis error, frequency response and base line drift.
ate
There are two different principles used to convert nonelectrical
variables into electrical signals. One of these is energy conversion
transducers based on this principle are called active transducers. The
other principle involves control of an excitation voltage or modulations
of a carrier signal. Transducers based on this principle are called passive
transducers. The two transducer types will be described separately in
the following sections.
AGTIVE TRANSDUCERS
yM
A11 physical principles can be employed for converting nonelectrical activity
in active transducers. But, not all principles are of practical importance
in the design of actual transducers, specially for biomedical applications.
In active transducers, in some cases the same transduction principle
used to convert from a nonelectrical form of ener$i can also be used in
reverse direction to covert electrical ener5/ to nonelectrical forms. Say,
a magnetic loudspeaker can also be used in the opposite direction as a
microphone. There are severatr names used to refer to the same effect
$rhen used in opposite direction because two applications were discovered
by different persons' Few methods of eners/ conversion used in active
tranducers are given in table 3.1.
ud
Transducers 37
l
voltage proportional to the rate of change of magnetic field is induced.
If a current is sent through the same conductor, a mechanical force is
ria
developed which is proportional to the current and magnetic field. The
result which depends on the polarities of voltage and current on the
electrical side or the direction of force and motion on the mechanical
side is a conversion from mechanical to electrical energz or vice_versa.
A11 electrical motors, generators, solenoids and loudsp"r1..." are based
on this principle of magnetic induction.
ate
yM
Fig. 3.1. lnductive transducers with rotary movement
one basic configuration of transducer that use the principle of
magnetic induction for the measurement of rotary motion is shown in
hgure 3.1. The output voltage in each case is proportional to the linear
or angular velocity. The most important biomedical applications are:
I (a) Heart Sound Microphones
t
(b) Pulse Transducers
i (c) Electromagnetic Blood Flow Meters.
3
Magnetic induction has an electrostatic equivalent called electric
induction. condenser microphone based on this principle is not widely
ud
l
to make the whole circuit f?om the two metals used in the thermocouple
can be overcbme by using a double reference junction that connects
ria
to
copper conductors as shown in the figure 3'2'
Metal B
ate
Copper
Junctions
Fig. 3.2. Thermocouple with double reference junction to connect to
measurement circuit using copper wtre
Duetotheirlowsensitivitythermocouplesarenotusedinthe
measurement of physiological temperatures'
The thermoelectric effect to convert from thermal to electrical enerSr
peltier
is called the seebeck effect. In the reverse direction it is called the
effect where the flow of current causes one junction to heat and the
other to cool. The peltier effect is sometimes used to cool parts of
yM
instruments.
3.3.3. Piezoelectric Effect
If pressure is applied to certain nonconductive materials so that and
d.eformation takes plu."., a charge separation occurs in the materials
an electrical voltage vp, cant be measured across the material. The natural
crystals
material where piezoeiectric effect can be observed are slices from
of q'.artz (Si O2i or Rochelle Salt (Sodium potassium tartrate, KNaCoHoOu'
+rrrol which liave been cut at a certain angle with respect to the crystal
axis. Piezoelectric properties can be introduced into wafers of barium
titanate.
ud
Force
St
Transducer AmPlifier
Transducers 39
l
-------> Trace 1
Time i
ria
Trace 2
ate
yM
Trace 4
l
the output voltage is quite high this approach may be permissible.
If the produet of resistance and capacitance is made much smaller
ria
than T, the voltage at the amplifrer input is proportional to the time
derivative of the force at the transducer or proportional to the rate at
which the applied force changes as shown in trace 3. If the product of
R and c is of the same order as 7, the resulting voltage is a compromise
between the extreme of two previous traces shown in trace 4. As any
mechanical input may contain various frequencies, a distortion of the
waveform of the resulting signal can occllr, if these relationships are not
ate
taken into account.
The piezoelectric principle is used in measurement of heart sound or
other atoustical signals .from within the body. The piezoelectric
transducers are used widely in ultrasonic instruments as transmitter
and receiver of ultrasonic signals. Principle of ultrasonic instrument is
discussed in other chapters of the book.
PASSIVE TRANSDUCERS
A or an ac carrier signal ]Jtllize the principle of
d.c excitation voltage
yM
controlling passive transducers. The transducer consists of a usually
passive circuit element which changes its value as a function of the
physicd.l variable to be measured. The transducer is a part of circuit
element, normally an arrangement like Wheatstone bridge, which is
powered by an ac or d.c. excitation, signal. The voltage at the output
ieflects the physical variable. There are only three passive circuit elements
which can be utilized as passive transducers namely: resistors, capacitors
and ind.uctors. It may also be noted. that active components like transistors
can also occasionallv be used. The active and passive have different
meaning in components and transducers. Passive transducers cannot be
operated. in the reverse direction unlike active transducers'
ud
t
sensitivity but bad frequency response. A different type of photoelectric (
transduclr is photo diode, which utilises charge carriers generated by
incident radiation in a reverse-biased diode function. Although less s
t
Page No. 40 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation t
Transducers 41
l
The transducer in most of the cases utilize a resistir.e element called
lr
ria
the strain gauge.
IC
rt
If an axial force is applied to the olement to cause it to stretch, its
iength increases by an amount. This stretching causes the cross sectional
rf
area of the cylinder to decrease. trither an incr-ease in length or decrease
ie
in cross section area result in increase of resistance. ,ihe ratio of the
v resulting resistance change. AR/R to the change in length LLI L is called
e
gauge factor, G. Thus,
rt
AR/R
ate
c_
rf LLIL
C
The strain gauge principle can be utilized for transducers in a number
r of different ways. In the mercury strain ga.-rge which is sometimes called
s
whitness Mercury Strain Gauge named afier its inverter the resistive
material consists of a column of mercury enclosed in a piece of silicon
rubber tubing. There use is limited in the measurement of physiological
rzariables due to the dimension of such gauges. This type of g^rg1 i"
used in plethysmograph.
f
The metaliic strain gauges are extensivery used rather than rnercury;
yM
the possible amount of stretching and the corresponding resistance
t
changes are much more limited. Metal strain gauges are of two different
types: unbounded and bonded. In the unbounded strain gauge a turn
I
wire is stretched between insulating posts. By connecting the four strain
i
gauges into a bridge circuit, all resistance changes influence the or,rtput
voltage in the same direction increasing the sensitivities by a factoi of
i
4. The resistance change due to ter,perature is compensatecl. The
unbonded strain gauge is basicary a force transducer. The same principre
is also used for other variables. The blood pressure transducer uses the
unbound strain gauge.
In bonded strain gauge, a thin wire shaped in zigi.g pattern is
ud
L
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
42 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
pattern on the silicon surface. Such strain gauge uses photographic and
diffusion techniques which is used in the manufacturing of integrated
circuits. The gauges are isolated from the silicon substrate by reverse
biased diode junction. Due to changes in the resistance of the
l
semiconductor strain gauge due to temperature change, at least two
strain gauges rare used. One strain gauge is used for temperature
ria
compensation.
ate
Strain Gage Wire
Grid
(this is cemented
between the bottom
and top covers when
assembled)
Transducers 43
gap in the magnetic path of the core is varied to change the effective
permeability. The same principle is used in active transducers in which
the rnagnetic path includes a permanent rrragnet.
The change in inductance in these types of transducers is not
l
related linearly to the displacement of the coi1. This difficulty is overcome
in the linear variable differential transformer (LVDT) . It consists of a
ria
transformer with one prirnary and two secondary windings. The
secondary windings are connected so that their induced voltages oppose
each other. If the core is in the centre position, the voltages in the two
secondary windings are equal in magnitude and the resulting output
voltage is zero. If the core is moveci upward as indicated by the arrow
in figure 3.6, the voltage in secondary 1 increases while that in secondary
decreases. The magnitude of the output voltage changes with the amount
ate
of displacement of the core from its central or neutral position. Its
phase with respect to the voltage at the primarv- winding depends on
the direction of the displacement. The non linearities in the magnitudes
of the voltages induced in the two output coils compensate each other,
the output voltage of the differential transducer is proportional to the
core movement.
3.4.3. Passive Transducers Using Active Circuit Elements
Active' and passive' distinction when ursed for circuit elements is
based on a different principle than that which is used for transducers.
yM
Active circuit elements are those which provide power gain for a signals
as in case of a transistors. The active circuit elements are normally used
in passive transdurcers.
The application of active circuit element in passive transducers is in
the area of photo electric transducers. The efficiency of photo diode can
be increased if we make a photo transistor.
Hall generator is another semiconductor transducer element which
provides an output voltage that is proportional to both applied current
and any magnetic field in which it is placed.
3.4.4. Passive Transducers Using Capacitive Elements
ud
l
Force (or pressure) Piezoelectric
Strain gauge
ria
a
Surface strain Strain gauge
Velocity Magnetic induction
Displacement Variable resistance
Variable capacitance
Variable inductance
LVDT
Mercury strain gauge
Temperature Thermocouple
ate
Thermistor
Light Photovoltaic
Photoresistive
Magnetic field Ha1l effect
Transducers 45
l
corrugated diaphragms have also occasionally been used in transducers
ria
which employ tfre variable reluctance or variable capacitance principles.
SENSORS
Each time heart muscle contracts, blood is ejected from the ventricles.
consequently, a pulse pressure is transmitted through the circulatory
system. This pulse causes vessel-wall displacement while travelling
through the vessels. The displacement is measurable at various points
ate
of the peripheral circulatory system. The pulse sensing can he clone by
placing finger tip over the radial artery in wrist or some other location
where an artery is just below the spin. The pulse pressure can be
measured by various transducers such as:
(z) Photoelectric pulse transducer.
(ir) Piezoelectric arterial pulse receptor.
(lir) Strain gauge pulse transducer.
3.6.1. Photoelectric Pulse Transducer
Pulsatile blood volume changes are detected by photoelectric method
yM
using photo-resistors. The methods used are:
(rj Transmittance method.
(izJ Reflectance method.
Transmittance method has a miniature lamp and photo-resistor
mounted in an enclosure which files over the tip of subject,s finger. Light
is transmitted through the finger tip of the patient's finger ana tne
resistance photo-resistor is determined by the amount of light reaching
photo-resistor. The figure 3.8 shows this method.
Photo-resistor
ud
St
\rr r
Lamp
Fis. 3.8. Transmission method of pulse sensing
Page No. 45 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
resistor is a part of a voltage divider circuit which produces a voltage'
The voltage varies with the amount of blood in the finger. This voltage
ria
closely foilows the pulse pressure and its wave shape can be recorded
or displayed on an oscilloscoPe.
In reflectance method, the photo-resistor is placed adjacent to the
exciter lamp. Only a part of light rays, emitted by the lamp, is reflected
and scattered. from the skin and tissue is made to fall on photo-resistor'
Figure 3.9 shows the reflectance method. The blood saturation of the
calpillaries determine the quantity of light reflected. The resistance of the
ate
photo-resistor varies due to above. The voltage across the photo-resistor
which is connected as a voltage divider, varies in proportion to the
volume changes of blood vessels of the body of the subject'
Finger
\tlr
yM
Photo-resister
Fig. 3.9. Reflectance method of pulse sensing
pressure ,r"ri.tior," in the air column inside the plastic tubing. At the
lnd ofthe tube, a piezoelectric transducer converts the Dressure changes
to electrical signal. This electrical signal is amplified and displayed or
recorded.
3.6.3. Strain Gauge Pulse Transducer
Displacement of the vessel wall is transferred to semiconductor strain
gage uy mans of a feeler pin and a leaf spring. Figure 3.1O shows the
St
It.li" !.rg" firmly attached to the leaf spring on one side and to feeler
pin on tn" otfr"t side leaf. One ring around the feeler pin of the transducer
irelps in minimizing the interference caused by unsteadiness of application
of transducer to subjects skin. The transducer output range is of 50 mv
for 0.1 mm displacement. The internal resistance and resonant frequency
of undamped mechanical system are 1 kw and 150 Hz respectively.
Page No. 46 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Transducers 47
Feeler pin
l
ria
Fig' 3'10' Strain gauge purse transducer
(courtesy Herren and Beneken,lgTo)
ate
RESPIRATION SENSOR
l
light source and an array of photodetectors, usually made up of photo
ria
diodes or phofio transistors are used to obtain a digital signal in parallel
format that indicates the position of the encoding plate and thereby
represents the displacement being measured.
ate
The active transducers convert non electrical activity to electrical
activity. In most of the cases the action is reversible. The important
acrive transducers uses magnetic induction. Under this category the
biomedical applications are :
(o) Heart Sound MicroPhones
(b) Pulse Transmitters
(c) Electromagnetic Blood Flow Meter
The other effect used. are thermoelectric effect, piezoelectric effect'
2 Passive Transducers: The passive transducers are those transducers
which utilize the principle of controlling a dc excitation voltage or an
yM
ac carrier signal.
transducer the most important is a resistive element
auge. Usually, two types of strain gauge is unbounded
form is used. The gauge factor is defined as the ratio
of resulting resistance change to the change is length G can be
written as
AR/R
^ _ LLIL
L'J-
The gauge factor for metals is of the order of 2, whereas the gauge
factor for silicon (a crystalline material) is about 120'
ud
t*ercidra
1. Discuss four different
3. types of transducers, explaining what they measures
48 oftheir
Page No. and
princiPles.
328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation I
Transducers 49
3.2. What do you understand by the term "gauge factor"? (UPTU, MQP-I)
3.3. Discuss the relationship among displacement, velocity, acceleration and
force.
3.4. What are the various effects of a transdrlcer on various biomedical
l
measurements? (UPTU-2OO3)
3.5. List and {iscuss briefly the various t5rpes of transducers used for Bio-
ria
medica-l applications. (UPTU-2OO4)
3.6. What is the difference between active and passive transducer? Explain
working principle of any active transducer. (UPTU-MQP, 1)
3.7.. Write in detail about underlying principles in different types of transducers.
Also discuss their function in the Bio-medical instruments.
(uPru-MQP,2)
aa]
ate
yM
ud
St
l
ria
Electrodes
>* fnside
4.
this chapter
1. Introduction
4.2. Electrode Theory
4.3. Biopotential Electrodes
4.4. Biochemical Transducers
ate
yM
4.5. Exampies of Eiectrodes
4.6. Summary
devices that convert ionic potentials into electronic potentials are called
electrodes. The design of electrodes are dependent an understanding
bioelectric potentials in general and measurement of pH, Po, and P"o,
of the blood in particular.
l
-.-:asuring circuit for some in the
time over which the Leasurement is done.
- ideal conditionsn, this current should
ria
be very small. The electrodes
'--ould have the capability of conducting a current across
the interface
::ween the body and electronic measuring circuit.
The electrode carries rout a transducing function since current
is
':ried out in the body through ions. It is carried in the erectrodes ancr
'' lead wire by electrons. trlectrode has a transducer to change
an ionic
-rrent into an electric current.
1'he figure 4.1 illustrates the erectrode-electrolyte interface. The
ate
.:ctrode to the electrolyte net current flow consists of:
iiJ electrons moving in a direction opposite to that of the
correction
the electrode.
irl Cations i.e., C* moving in the same direction as the current.
Anictn i.e., A moving in opposite direction of the current.
"rl
C
C -------+
(_e <-._-
A
C
{ft?3
yM
+_e C
---_->
C
<-A-
(_e
C-
Electrode Electrolyte
Fig. 4.1. Electrode_electrolyte interface
These are no free electrons for charge to cross the interface,
i.e., no
.e electrons in electrolyte or no free cations or anions in the electrode,
-.:refore, chemicai reactions occur
at the interface:
Ca)Cn* +ne
ud
Am- _rr
ABES LIBRARY
-) a- me Acc
rvhere n = Valence of C
m = Valence of A
It is presumed that the erectrode is made up of some atoms of the
:re material as the cations ancl this materiar in the erectrode at the
-erface can be oxidized to from
a cation and some free electrons. The
'ion is discharged into the erectrolyte. The erectron serves as a charge
St
oxidations re
is crossing th
the oxidation
l
direction, the reduction reactions dominate'
ria
t
4.2. ELECTRODE THEORY
The interface of metallic ions in solutions with their associated metals
gives an electrical potential which is called the electrode potential' The
Electrode potential i" . of the difference in diffusion rates of
"ot."qence
ions into and out of the metai. The formation of a layer of charge at the
interface is created due to equilibriam. It is a double layer charge' The
layer nearest to the metallic is one polarily and the layer next to the
ate
is opposite polarity. Hydrogen is non-metalic and this also has
"olrtion
electrode potlntial *h"., it is interfaced with associated ions in solution'
It is not ptssible to determine the absolute electrode potential of a single
electrod,e since measurement of potential across the electrode and its
ionic solution would need placement of another metallic interface in the
solution. Hence, all electrode potentials are actually relative values and
accordingly must be stated with respect to some reference. Hydrogen lu
electrode considered stand.ard is assigned zero volts. The Table 4' 1 gives r
electrode potentials. ust
yM
Table 4.1. Electrode Potentials (examples)
*r
K, +K* - 2.925
Cr Cr2* - 0.913
------>
Zn<-> Zn2* - 0.762
ud
Cdl----->g4zl - o.402
Co7-Co2* - 0.277
Electrodes 53
l
ria
_ = tGT\ (c^, \
E - [ #,1'" u*.i a bvorts
I
.or "
G = gas constant (9.315 x 107 ergs/mole/degree kelvin)
7 = Absolute temperature, <J.egrees kelvin
n = valance of the ion ie number of electrons added or
subtracted to ionize the atom.
ate
F = Faraday constant (96500 coulombs)
ca, cb = two concentrations on both sides of the membrane.
: fo, fo = respective_ activity coefficients of the ion on both
I sides of the membrane.
e 1 standard volt = 108 abovolts.
I urement of
I known
is electrodes occurs
S :: an electro ducers
-se both membrane barriers and metalelectrolyte interfaces.
yM
BIOPOTENTIAL ELECTRODES
: -opotential electrodes have metalelectrolyte
interface. Electrode potential
: developed across the interface which is proportional to the exchange
- ions between the metal electrolytes of the body.
ud
gl---------o
Body of
Electrode
l
Ror (body fluids)
ria
ate
Fig. 4.2. (b) Equivalent circuit for measurement of biopotentials with two electrodes
The figure a.2@l and (b) represent the impedence of electrodes which
is frequen-cy dependent because of the effect of the capacitance. In addition
both the elecrode potential and the impedence vary due to effect of
polarization. Polarization is due to direct current passing through the
metal-electrolyte interface. The net effect is similar to charging of a
e
a
yM
battery u,itJr the polarity of the charge opposing the battery with the
polariiy of the charge opposing the florv of current that generates the
.t If the amplifier to which the electrodes are connected have very
^rg".
high input impedance, the effect of polarizatl.on is minimized. Larger
etectrodes have lower impedance , i.e., 2 to 1o kQ. The bipolar electrodes
are of three types-micro electrodes, skin surface electrodes and needlr:
electrodes.
The interface between the electrorle-electroJyte and the skin should be
understood to have clear picture of the behaviour of electrodes. A
transparent electrolyte gel containing cl- as the principal anion is used
to couple an electrohe to the skin. The gel gives a good contact. Similarl1'
an electrode cream containing C1- rnay also be used. A brief understanding
ud
Electrodes 55
Stratum Corneum
e
"Barrier"
-<:*-:-t/
a
//
/t I
Stratum Granulosum
l
',- /)
Stratum Germinativum
ria
Corium
Eoidermis
Pore
{ Papillae
Capillary Loop
I
oermis
J
Sweat Duct
i
I
L Sweat Gland
ate
Fig. 4.3. A cross-section diagram of skin
The electric connection between the electrode and the skin through
::ectrolyte gel is sho,*,n in figure 4.4. Tihe electrode-electrolyte interface
:quivalent circuit is also shown side by side and details of the same are
-s follows:
yM
R. = effective resistance associated with interface effects of
the gel between the electrode and the skin.
ud
R1
Dermrs and
Subcutaneous Laryer
St
{
Fig. 4.4. A body-surface electrode placed against the skin. Electrical equivalent
lircuit elements are approximately the same level at which physical process exists
&" = potential difference due to ionic concentration across
epidermis or atleast stratum corneum as a semipermeable
membrane.
Page No. 55 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
56 Fundarnentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
l
The effect of the stratum corneum may be reduced by vigrous rubbing
with a pad sbaked in acetone or abrading the stratum corneum with
ria
sanclpaper to puncture it. This process shorts 8"., C" and R" for stability.
The fluid secreted by sweat glands contains Na*, K* and Cl- ions and
concentrations differ from those in extra cellular fluid. Hence, there is
potential difference between luman of the swert duct and dermis and
subcutaneous layers. There are also a paraiiel Rrc, combination in
series with this potential that represents the wall of the sweat gland and
duct, These components are generally neglected when we consider
ate
biopotential electrodes.
If a polarizable electrode is in contact with electrolyte, a double layer
of charge forms at the interface. The movement of electrode with respecr
to electrolyte mechanically disturbs the distributjon of potential until
equilibrium can be reestablished. If a part of electrodes is in a electrolyte
and one moves whole of the other remains statinary, a potential differerrce
appears between the two electrodes during this movement. This potentiai
is called motion artifact which can be a serious cause of interference in
the measurement of bio-potentials.
The motion artifacts results primarily from mechanical disturbances
yM
of the distribution of charge at electrode-electrolyte interface. It is
reasonable to expect that motion artifact is minimal for nonpoiatizable
electrodes.
4.3.1. Microelectrodes
These have tips small enough to penetrate a single cell and as such
readings from within single cell can be obtained. Microelectrodes are of
two types-metal and micropipet. Metal microelectrodes are constntcted
by electrolytically etching the tip of a fine tungsten or stainless steel wire
to the ciesired size. Subsequently the wire is coated almost to the tip
with insulating material. Special electolytic processing is also done on
ud
the tip to lower the impedence. The ion-metal interface happens at the
point of contact betweenmetal tip and the electrolytes either insicle or
outside the cell.
The micropipet type of electrode is actually a glass micr:opipet rr,ith
the tip of the desired stze (i.e. about 1 micron).
The micropipet is filled with an electrolyte suitable "vith cellular
fluids. Such microelectrode is having dual interface. One interface is
comprised. of a metal wire in contact with the electrolyte solution inside
St
the micropipet and the other is the interface between eJ.ectrolyte inside
the pippet and the fluids inside or immediately outside the cell.
One microelectrode is shown in figure 4.5.
A thin film of precious metal is bonded to the outside of a drawn
glass microelectrode. Such microelectrodes are very reliable and having
Page No. 56 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Electrodes 57
l
t
ria
I
Metallic
Resin lnsulatron Thin Film
i Gold Plateci Pin Connector
5
Fig. 4.5. Microelectrode with metal film on glass
i
l 4.3.2. Body Surface Electrodes
i These are used to get bioelectric potentials from surface of the body
r and are available in different sizes and forms. Larger electrodes are
ate
generally used in ECG as localZation of the measurement is not important.
r Smaller electrodes are suitable in EEG and EMG measurements.
r
,] Floating electrode is available. This electrode practically eliminates
ii
.novement of artifact by avoiding any direct contact of the rnetal with the
i'
skin. The electrolyte paste or jelley serves as condnctive path bet.veen
t :he metal and skin. The ligure 4.6 shows a floating electorde. Spraton
Ll
:lectrodes are made for astronauts. Other special surface electrodes are
n
iisposable electrodes and ear-dip electrode. etc.
S Plastic or Rubber
yM
Lead Wire
S
Support and Spacer
e
Space for Sudace
Electrode Jelly
Fig. 4.6. Floating electrode
re
)r
Fig. 4"7. Needle electrode for EEG
h For EMG applications, needle electrodes are basically of hne insulated
..r'ires placedso that their tips (base) are in contact with the nerve,
IT nuscle or the tissue from whose measurement is to be made. The
1S :emaining wire is insulated to avoid shorting. Wire electrodes of copper
le :r platinum are used for EMG pickup from specific muscles.
St
l
method of such method is that one electrode used is sensitive to substance
or ion being qLeasured and the second electrode used is insensitive to
ria
that substance or the ion being measured. The second electrode is known
as reference electrodue whereas hrst electrode is known as active electrode.
ate
electride potential. The reference electrode basic conhguration is shown
in figure 4.8.
yM
lnternal Ag/AgCl
or Colonel
Filling Solution
ud
Liquid Junction
Electrodes 59
l
4.9. Inside the glass blub a highly acidic buffer solution is put. A silver-
ria
silver chlorode e'kctrode is used in this case. The pFr measurement is
done by using glass electrode for pH measurement as shown in the
figure 4.9 along with reference elecrode already described. A combination
electrode as shown in the figure 4.10 is available having both pH glass
electrode and reference electrode.
The impedences of pH electrodes vary from 50 to 500 MQ. The input
impedence of ttre meter must have extremely high value for proper
measurement.
ate
To Meter for To Meter for
Measurement Measurement
yM
Reference
Ag/AgCI
Wire Contact
pH Glass
Buffered
Solution
Fig. 4.9. Glass electrode for Fig. 4.10. Combination electrode for
pH measurement pH measurement
ud
Microammeter
lnsulatron
l
Ag/Agcl Reference
Electrode
ria
Electrolyte Solution
where in O, can diffuse
Platinum Wire
Membrane through
which C, can Ciffuse
ate
Solution in which
Measurement is Made
The insulation of the lead rvire and the electrode is aiso a protliern"
The environment around electrodes is very humici or continualil, 5o.i."o
in extracellular fluid or even in cleaning solution. These insulations are
mace of polymeric material so that it can absorb water. It is important
l
that the insulation material used with electrode shourd be pr-oper to
ar.roid such prpblems.
ria
ELECTRODES
Figure 4.12. shows body surface biopotentiai electrodes. Metal-plate
electrode is used for application to limbs. Metal-disk electrode is used
with surgicai tape. Disposable foam-pad electrodes are frequently used
with electrocardiographic monitoring equipments.
ate
The disposable foram-pad type electrode consists of a large disk of
plastic foam material with silver plated disk on one side attached to a
silver-plated snap similar to that used on clothing in the center of other
side.
Figure 4.13 shows a metallic suction electrode. It is a modification
of the metal-plate electrode that requires no staps or ad.hesives for
holding it in place. It consists of a hollow metallic cylindrical electltode
which makes contact with the skin at its base.
yM
Foam Pad
Adhesive Tack on
ud
l
Rubber
ria
Buib
Lead Wire--r
T-"rr-rnal
ContarJ
ate
S urface
lnsulating
Package
Electroyte Gel
in Recess
yM
(b)
(a)
il n nn
Dead Cellular Material
Fig. 4.14. Floating metal-body electrodes: (a) Recessed electrode with top-hat
structure, (b) Cross-sectional view of above, (c) Cross-sectional view of a disposable
recessed electrode of similar type
Figure 4.15 shows flexible body-surface electrodes. These ale carbon
filled siticone rubber electrode and flexible thin-film neonatal electrode.
cross-sectional view of the thin-film electrode is also shown. A pin
connector is pushed into the lead connector hole of hgure a.15(a). Flexible
St
l
ria
Pin Connector
(a)
Lead Wire
ate
AgCl Film
Ag Film
13-p{hick
Mylar Substrate
Conducting (c)
Adhesive
Fi9.4.15. Flexible body surfface electrode (a) Carbon-filled silicone rubber electrode,
(b) Flexible thin-film neonatal electrode, (c) Cross-sectional view
yM
Hypodermic Wire
ud
Needle
Hypodermic
Electrodes Needle
Uninsulated
Barb
Skin
St
Muscle
(e) (0
Fig. 4.16. Needle and wire electrode (a) lnsulated needle electrode, (b) Coaxial
electrode, (c) Bipolar coaxial needle electrode, (d) and (f) Method of uses in skin
Page No. 63 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
attached to fetal skin by corkscrew type action. The peak amplitude
ria
.roltage in such cb.ses is 50-700 pV.
Suction Cup
F tal Skin
Electrode
Referenc:
Electrode Electrode
-
ate
Lead Wire
\(b
(c) ""-@
Fig. 4.17. Electrodes used during labor (a) Suction electrode,
(b) Cross-sectional view of ahove, (c) Helical electrode
i
yM
il
other is the interface between electrolyte inside the pipet and the
fluids inside or immediately outise the cell.
4 Body Surface Electrodes: These are electrodes which are used to
get bioelectric potentials from the surface of the body and are available
in different sizes and forms.
Biochemical Transducers: Biochemical transducers measure the
concentr:ation of an ion or of a certain gas dissolved in blood or some
St
other liquid.
6 Reference Electrodes: The hydrogen gas/hydrogen ion interface works
as the reference and is assigned zero volts.
The pH Electrode: The pH rneasurement is done by using glass
electrode along with reference electrode. A combination electrode for
Electrodes 65
l
be exposed to the electrolyte all of the same material. A third material
ria
say solids shduld not be used to connect the electrode to its leaci ""vire
unless it is certain that this material will not be in contact with the
electrolyte.
10. Examples of Electrodes: Electrodes used for application limbs,
surgical tape, disposable electrodes, electrodes for infants,
intracutaneous needle electrodes, and suction electrodes used during
labour pain are available.
ate
OXerCkle,J
JJJ
ud
St
l
ria
Cardiovascular Measurements
'lr
ll
1[
,{i
i
5.2.
5.3.
5.4.
chapter
ion
Cardiovascular System
Electro Cardiography
ate
Blood Pressure Measurement
yM
5.5. Measrrrement of Blood Flo,"r, and Cardiac Output
5.6. Measurement of Heart Sound
5.7. Plethysmography
5.8. Sumrnarl'
66
Cardiovascular Measurements 67
l
ria
ate
Fig. 5.1. Hofler machine usage and block diagram
CARDIOVASCULAR SYSTEM
re cardiovascular system is known as circulating system. It transports
.'ltrients, gases and wastes to and from cells oruoay. The cardiovascular
'-"
stem is composed of the heart, brood vessels, cefls and plasma which
--ake up the blood. A cardiovascular system is shown in figure 5.2 (a)
=:d figure 5.2 (b) shows a basic analogr of cardiovascular system.
yM
The heart is like a two stage pump, physically arranged in parallel
: :t with the circulating blood passing through t-he pumps
in a series
::quence' The right half of the hea't is the pump thal suppries blood
-:--: rest of the system. to
The circulatory path for blood-flow through the
-:-rgs is called the pulmonary circulation and the circulatory system
-' at supplies oxygen and nutrients
to the cells of the body is cauea tne
i stemic circulation. Figure 5.3 shows a cutway view of heart with blood
: :ulation.
The systemic circulation is a high resistance circuit with a large
:-:ssure gradient between the arteriels and veins. The pump constituting
- -. left heart
may be considered 6rs a pressure pump. The muscle
,: :traction of the left heart is larger ,and stronger than tirat of the
ud
The pipes which in this case are ar-teries and the veins are not rigid
-- t-lexible. They are capable of helpinl3 and controlting blood circulation
-reir own muscular action and thei,r ,wn valve and receptor system.
'd is not a pure Newtonian fluid; rrrther, it possesses properties that
rot always comply with the rawsi governing hydrauric motion. In
: :.:ion the blood needs the help of the lungs for
- the supply of oxygen.
-s the system can not be oversiml:rified and could teah to error.
Page No. 67 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
Carotid arterY
Jugular vein (also subclavian
(also subclavian
artery to arms)
vein {rom arms)
ate
Pulmonary
artery
Superior
vena cava
lnterior
vena cava
yM
mesenteric
hepatic vein
arteries
hepatic
portal vein
SU
ud
renal artery
rh
be
rto
--ts
a1s
thi
:11(
ric
St
:lo
1.runk and legs
'al
'r-h
Cardlovascular Measurements 69
l
ria
ate
yM
pulmonary artery divides many times into smaller and smaller arteries'
which becomes arterioles with extremely small cross sections. These
arterioles supply blood to the alveolar capillaries, in which exchange of
oxygen ,rra .aruo, dioxide takes place. On the other side of the lung
l
in which s fed into tiny
-^i i" a sin-rilar construction
ria
veins. The tiny veins combine to form larger n turn combine
until ultimateiy all the oxygenated blood is the pulmonary
vein to the heart.
From the pulmonary vein the blood enters the left atrium and from
there it is pr-rmped thrtugh the mitral or bicuspid valve, into the left
ventricle by contraction oithe atrial muscles. when the left ventricular
muscles contract, the pressure prod.uced by the contraction mechanically
closesthemitralvalveandthebuiltupofpressureintheventriclethe
ate
forces the aortic valve to open, causing the blood to rush from
1
t
ventricle into the aorta. It may be noted that this action takes place (
synchronously with the right ventricle' 1
Theheartpumpingcycleisdividedintotwomajorparts:systoleand t
diastole. Systole is a"fr.t"a as the period of contraction of the heart
muscle, specifrcally the ventricular ruscle at which time blood is pumped
into the pulmonary artery and the aorta. Diastole is the period of
{ 1
I
Deoxygenated
blood 5;
Superior lungs Left subclavian arterY
{
To left lungs :h,
To right lungs,J rit
From left lungs
lr
From right rfr
LA
lungs th,
:n(
ud
_f,
Aorta
once the blood has been pumped into the arterial system, the hear
relaxes the pressure in the hiart chambers d.ecreases the outlet valves
closes and ln a short time the inlet valve open again to restart the
diastole and initiate a new cycle in the heart'
The b100d reaches the brain and other extremities after passlx
through many bifurcations of the arteries' The last stage is gradu
Page No. 70 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
decrease in the cross section and the increase in the number of arteries
until the smallest type which is called arterioles is reached. These feed
rnto the capillaries where oxygen is supplied to the cells and carbon
dioxide is received from the, cells.'
l
Some values of interst in the cardiovascular system in engineering
ria
are: the heart beats ab an average rate of 75 beats/minute in a normal
adult. The heart rate increases when a person stands up or do some
:xercise, decreases when he lies down. The normal range is between
c0 to 85. on the average it is higher in women. In an infant the heart
-ate may be as high as 140 beats per minute under normal conditions.
lhre heart rate also increases with heat exposure and other physioiogical
.rd psychological factors.
The heart pumps about 5 litres of blood per minute, the average
ate
--ood volume in average adult is about 5 to 6litres. Thus approximately
--e whole blood is circulated every minute during rest. with exercise
the
-:culation rate is increased 'considerably. At any given time, about
-r-80% of the blood volume is in
- e remainder jn the capillaries. the veins about 2o./o in arteries and
Systolic blood pressure in the normal adult is in the range of 95 to
:lJ mm of mercury (Hg) with 120 being average. These figures are
i -.'cject to much variation with age, climate, eating habits and other
'---tors. Normal diastole pressure ranges from 60 to
90 mm of Hg and
: mm of Hg being average. This pressure is usually measured in the
yM
: -=chial artery in the arm. The normal value of blood pressure is given
i -rvstole pressure/diastoic pressure as l2Ol80.
10 mm
(1 mV)
St
----------)Time
Fig. 5.4. (a) A typical normal electrocardiogram
Page No. 71 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
SA node
Aotron potential
Superior vena cava Atrial muscle
l
,AV node
Sinoatrial node
ria
LAF
lnte rnodal
path\i!ays Cr:r-nrnoir bunCle
Atr loveirtricu!ar-j-
node
BLINclIE OT HIS
I
-..,.
Right bundle
ate
branch
Purl" inje
5\rsielr)
I aTi noslci"tor
a 2 0.4 0.6
Cardiovascular Measurements 7i
-: AV node. A heart block might be indicated of one or
more of the basic
:atures are missing in ECG.
: fifl:';e,s:h:?:::i:tJ,hffTtriil11i:#iil
l
r.rr.r,"." tr,. .r""tri'"1?T,:t* HsH:I (whether erect or recumbent)
ria
An instrument used to obtain electrocardiogram is calred an
r':ctrocardiograph. The electrocardiograph was tite first
:::tronic device to find widespread rs. i,,medical diagnosticselectrical/
and still
-,-.: most important
toor for diagnosis of cardiac disoriers. Although it
:--r'ides invaluable diagnostic information in case of arrhythmia
and
tit
s.T
ate
for
fJ 1. ECG Amptifiers
-\ormal electronic amplifiers are norma-[y referencedto ground through
:-: power supplies. Thrs creates an interference prob[m
::irfiers are used to measure smal bioelectric potentials. when such
r -ally employed not only in electrocardiography
ihe technique
'-:surement of other bioelectric signals in the use but arso in the
of a
::-:fier. The principar of differential amplifier can be explaineddifferential
with the
yM
-- of figure 5.5.
ud
Bioelectronic
srgnal I
V*
St
TwoamplifierswithseparateinputsbutwithaCommonoutput is a
terminal which delivers the sum of two amplifiers output voltages
gain, but
differential amplifier. Both the amplifiers have the same voltage
phase with
one amplifier ls inverting (outpul voltage is 180" out of
l
respecttoinput)whiletheotherisnon_inverting(inputandoutput to the
ria
;;ii"g." .r" 1, prrasel. If the two amplifier inputs are connected
be zeto'
same input source, the resulting common mode gain should
becausethesignalsfromtheinvertingandnon-invertingamplilrerscancel
the two amplifiers
each other at the common output. However, the gain of
isnotexactlyequal,thiscancellationisnotcomplete.Asmallresidual
inputs is
common mode output remains. when one of the amplifier
grounded and a ,roliage is applied only
input' the
amp amplifrer'
input voltage appears ,t tn" output
ate
to the called the
The ratio of the differential galn
in modern
which
common mod.e rejection ratio-of the differential amplifier
amplihers can be as high as 10,OO,OOO:1'
Measurementofbioelectricsignalsthatoccurasapotentialdifference
The bioelectric
between two electrodes is an input to a differential amplifier'
inputs of the amplifrer'
signals are between the inverting and non-inverting
as though they
For the interference signal, hotiever, both inputs appear
smaller common
were connected togeth.i to '' common input source' Much
signal'
moa" gain amplifiers the common mode interference
divider
The electrode impedances R.* and R"- each form a voltage
yM
of thE differeniial amplifier as illustrated in
with the input ir.rp.d.r-r"e
figure 5.5(b).
signals
If the electrod.e impedance are not identical, the interference
lnpu amPliher
at the not take
may b egree
ances qual' the
place.
highcofadifferentialamplilrercanonlybe
realize impedance much higher as compared
to the imped.ance of the electrodes to which it is connected'
5.3.2. Electrodes
ud
Thepumpingactionoftheheartwhichgeneratsthevoltageisactual..
avectorquantitywheremagnitudeaswellasorientationchangeswi-- applied ::
the time because the ECG signal is measured from electrodes
rhe surface of the body, the"waveform of this signal is very depende:-:
ot the trace mai
on the placement of the electrode' Some of the segment
however,alrnostdisappearforcertainelectrodepositionwhereasothg
Page No. may
74show up clearly on the recording' For this reason 1n a norr-
of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
75 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
l
colour codes are used to identify each electrode
In this experimerrt, Einthoven had found it advantageous to record
ria
the electrocardiogram from electrodes placed vertically as well as
horizontally on the body of the patient. The leg selected was the left leg
probably because it terminates vertically below the heart. The early
electrocardiograph machine thus employed that electrodes of which only
two are used at one time. With the introduction of electronic amplifier
an additional connection to the body was needed as a ground reference.
It becomes a convention to use the free right leg as reference although
an electrode could have been positioned almost any where on the body'
c
(Brown)
ate
yM
RL (Green) L (Bed)
Fig. 5.6. (a) Abbreviations and colour codes used for ECG electrodes
ud
5.3.3. Leads
Four electrodes are used to record the electrocardiogram as shown
:: hgure 5.6 (a). The electrode on the right leg is only for ground reference.
Jtcause the input of the ECG recorder has only two terminals, a selection
:-ust be made among the available active electrodes. The 12 standard
=ads used most frequently are shown in figure 5.6 (b). The three
bipolar
-rb lead selections first introduced by Einthoven shown in the top row
St
l
V
ria
V
a
E
a
al
fo
sl
"ii,
lr
,l
,il,
1il
ate
(Augmented) Unipolar Limb Leads
Lead aVF
yM
ud
l
'.-ector. The assumption is made that the heart, i.e., the origin
of the
'.-ector is near the-,center of an equilateral triangle,
the apexes of which
ria
,re the right and left shoulder and the crotch. with this assumption the
-cG potential at the shoulders are essentially the same as the wrists
and that the potentials at' the crotch differ little from those at either
.nkle, he let the points of this triangle represent the electrode positions
:rrr three limb leads. The triangle known as the Einthoven triangle is
:hown in figure 5.7.
ate
yM
Left Leg
- he remaining leads are the unipolar type. For unipolar leads, the
' - -rocardiogram is recorded between a single exploratory and the
, :al terminal which has a potential corresponding to the center of
- cody. This central terminal is obtained by connecting the three
- '.'e limb electrodes together through resistors of equal size. The
-.:-tial at the connection point of the resistor corresponds to the
Page No. 77 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
78 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
l
exploratory electrode is not used for the central terminal, thereby
increasing the amplitude of the ECG signal without changing its
ria
waveform appreciably. The leads are designated as VR, VL and VF (F
as foot).
A single chest electrode is instead of the unipolar chest leads
sequentially placed on each of the six predesignated points on the chest
for the unipolar chest leads. These chest positions are called the precordial
unipolar leads and are designated 7, thrcugh Va. A separate chest
electrode is used as an exploratory electrode and all three active limb
electrodes are used to obtain the central terminal.
ate
The record of electrocardioolam from these 12 lead selections are
shown in figure 5.8(a) . It can be seen that the trace from lead selection
I or II resembles most closely the normal electrocardiogram waveform.
Appearance of some of the other traces are quite different.
,1,
tl
t;
\
xI
yM
\ 5.
t
oVu
ud
5
pe
CA
fr<
1n
str
1S
SC
an
St
irc
SO
of
aVF
:ht
Fig. 5.8. (a) Typical Patient ECG
In
Page No. 78 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Cardiovascular Measurements 79
l
shown in figure 5.8(b), (c) and (d).
ria
Fig. 5.8. (b) ECG recording with regular spreading of the curve with super imposed
ate
50 Hz power line intederence signals
Fig. 5.8. (c) Recording with irregular trembling of the ECG trace without wandering
of the base line but otherwise normal ECG trace
yM
Fig. 5.8. (d) ECG trace without wandering of the base line
--
cle, the other end of which plugs into the ECG recorder. The wires
_.
-:m the electrodes connect to the lead selector switch, which also
'.:orporates the resistors necessary for the unipolar leads. A
:-ndard.ization voltage of 1 mV to standardize or calibrate the recorder
. lsed.. An artifact on the recorded trace is introduced by changing the
. :ing. From the lead selector switch the ECG signal goes to a pre-
:-.ciiher, a differential amplifier with high common mode rejection. It is
St
l
ECG recorder can be used to record the output of other devices such as
ria
electromotograph which records the Achilles reflex. A position control on
the pen amplifier makes it possible to center the pen on the recording
paper.
Heat sensitive paper may be used ald the pen is actually an electrically
heated stylus, the temperature of which can be adjusted with a stylus
heat control for optimal recording trace. Normally, electrocardiograms
are recorded at a paper speed of 25 rr,rrrls, but a faster speed of 50 mm/s
is provided to allow better resolution of the QRS complex at very high
ate
heart rates or when a particular wave form details are required.
The protection of the electrocardiograph from damage during
defibrillation is a sevore problem. The voltages ihat may be encountered
in this case may be several thousand volts. Thus special protection must
be provided into the electrocardiograph to prevent burnout of components
a-nd its damage.
,rl.
lr
rll
\
yM
Driven
right leg
circuit
Amplifier
protection
circuit
ud
Operator
display
St
ECG analysis
program
Cardiovascular Measurements 81
t
r Few modern ECG machines do not connect the right leg of the
patient to the chasis, but utilize a "driven right leg lead". This involves
a summing network to obtain the sum of voltages from a-11 other electrodes
F and a driving amplifier, the output of which is connected to the right leg
l
F
of the patient. This arrangement gives a reference voltage at the right leg
F
ria
tr equivalent to the sum of voltages at the other electrodes alongwith a
a driver's amplifrer. This arrangement increases the common mode rejection
ratio of the overall system and reduces interference. It also has the effect
of reducing the current flow in the right leg electrode and thereby making
rB if safer. An ECG machine mechanism is shown in figure 5.10'
IA
ls
ate
D
la
d
Et
ts
Write
edge or
platen
yM
Permanent magnet
l
blcok diagram is shown in figure 5.11. br
ria
o
1' o) ' qQ r
'iEdPcE
=E
6 o-fxo
c)
J E=E6E grgE
a*-
rOf 3a= N u.rE t Satac**
aoo goo F-----O
-E
-Ll- c
BH*
o-E
,igEEo
E(!
Yir t-
oaE = o an
5EE
o
An
=
.oE
ate
(6tr re(
0-8
tin
lea
aul
pal
all
t, sut
,I
.t;
toi
\; o a A\ , c -.]
be
\ - the
=EH#d E
yM
EBaH$ EC(
qEe 5.3
-i5H bE
6z= g;
-^ ::z L
P
:naE
rypf
:arc
E ald
c :SA
0)
o
c
o
rrth
o Cimt
ud
= rp1
cein
:ispJ
:acl
i'hic
o
o
Y
r
-E 60I
-E
ot
ol
I
are
::gni
:tect
i
o 1i EE
St
J
-g tr 0) ECI oo-
0) EE 8q)
C E op
()E o-c
0)
(!
-J
t o)E
oo
o.p
L (E(d o
EE
Fig. 511. Ten patient electrode (12-lead) ECG block diagram
Page No. 82 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Cardiovascular Measurements 83
l
redside of a patient conveniently.
ria
In case, the ECG'of a patient is recorded in the 12 standard lead
:onfiguration, the resulting paper strip is from 3 to 6 feet long. It is very
rconvenient for the physicial to analyze the ECG.
5.3.5.2. Three Channel Recorders
The three channel recorder record the output of three leads at a time
':Ld there is automatic switching to record output of next three channels.
-.r electrocardiogram with the 12 standard, leads therefore, can be
ate
-=corded automatically as a sequence of four groups
of three traces. The
- re required for actual recording
is only 10 seconds. The groups of
=ads recorded and the time at which the switching occurs are
rtomatically identifred by code markings at the margin of the recording
:rDer. At the end of the recording standardizatron pulses are inserted in
.-- three channels. Although the actual recording time is reduced
;:bstantially compared to single channel recorders, more time is required
apply the electrodes to the patient because separate electrodes must
-. used for each chest position. It is much easier to read the output of
-.: three channel ECG recorder as compared to single channel
yM
:- - G recorder.
5 3.5.3. Vector Electrocardiographs (Vector cardiographs)
The voltage generated by the heart is described as a vector where
-.snitude and spatial change with time may be of importance. In the
- -: of ECG recorders described above only magnitude is recorded. vector
' ciography on the other hand presents an image of both the magnitude
, - :
the spatial orientation of the heart vector. The heart vector, however,
a three dimensional variable and three "views" or projections on
--:ogonal planes are necessary to describe the variable fully in two
': -:nsional figure. Special lead placement systems must be used to pick
: -he ECG signals for vector electrocardiograms, the Frank system
ud
:'* ,-g the one most frequently employed. The vectorcardiogram is usually
: ':.ayed on a cathode-ray tube similar to those used for patient monitors.
I : .:: QRS complex is displayed as a sequence of loops' on this screen,
't'
- -'h is then photographed with a polaroid camera. vector-cardiograms
r :lso available that use computer techniques to slow down the ECG
---.ils and to allow the recording of the vectorcardiogram with a
* :anical X-Y recorder.
St
l
1. A treadmill with automatic capability to change the speed and o
inclination in order to apply a specific physiological stress'
ria
S
3. An ECG monitor with a cathode ray display and heart rate meter. ry
br
4. An ECG recorder. S(
5. An automatic or semiautomatic sphygmomanometer for the indirect C(
measurement of blood Pressure. ht
A dc def,rbriller is usually kept available while the test is being
ate
m
performed. As the exercise stress test involves risk for patients with di
known or suspected cardiac disorders. aF
5.3.5.5. ECG Clinical Applications pa
rel
ECG can determine several defects and damages in human body.
Po
ECG can detect hypertrophy and atrial enlargement, atria-ventricular
CO:
conduction defect, intraventricular conduction defect, myocardial damage,
myocardia interaction and arrhythmta.
an
Interpretations of unsatisfactory ECG records help diagnosing above
clinical problems. The post-exercise judgements also come under clinical
yM
5.3
applications of ECG. ECG applications for clinical purposes are based on
the following techniques: act
(i) Vectror CardiograPh (VCG) cor
This helps in extracting cardiac activity of heart which is important of<
diagnostic information useful to doctors, before treating the patients. In of,
\rCG case, ECG is obtained along three axes at right angles to one con
another. Display oL x-a oscilloscope of any of these ECG as a vector is his
known as VCG. VCG gives a vectorial representation of the distributiot: The
of electrical signals generated by the heart and produces loop type patterns and
on the cRT screen. Norrnally a photograph is taken of each cardiac :he
& and ?vector loops are lc(
ud
repolarization of the arteria and ventricles can be found out form vcc _tse(
-.:rh.
The oldest method of clinical detection of heart sounds is the acoustica
stethoscope. A better technique but less dependable is the electron:'
stethoscope having a microphone, an amplifier and head set'
tll
The phonocardiograph is the latest instrument which records souni. - 100(
connected with pumping action of heart' -1VS-
:.OOC
Page No. 84 of 328. ntr
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Cardiovascular Measurements 85
The heart sounds give indication of the heart rate and its rhythmicity.
valve action and effectiveness of blood pumping informations are also
known from PCG. The heart sound is produced prominently by closure
l
of the ratios between upper and lower chambers of the heart. These
sounds have the frequencies ranging from 3O Hz to IOO Hz.
ria
one important aspect of PCG is the type of microphones. It is based
on the design such as the contact microphone or the air coupled
inicrophone. one of the microphones types can be piezo-electric crystal
based which generate potentials due to mechanical stresses due to heart
sounds. The other type of microphone is dynamic type based on a moving
:oil having fixed magnetic core inside it. The coil movement is with the
:reart sound which produces potential because of its interaction with
nagnetic flux. Another acoustic sensor is a polymer based adherent
ate
lifferential output sensor having thickness of just 1.0 mm. It can be
:pplied to the skin gel and two-sided adhesive material which fits the
:atient's body contour. This seirsor detects the motion of the skin which
. esults from acoustic energz incident upon it from within the soft
tissue.
?olyvinylidene fluorrde (PVDF), a piezo-electric polymer is the main sensing
, rmponent.
The amplitude used for PCG has a frequency range of 20 Hz to 2 kHz
..:rd suitable frequency bands are selected by using appropriate filters.
3.5.6. Gontinuous ECG Recording
yM
5
A normal electrocardiogram represent only a brief sample of cardiac
' tivity, arrhythmias which occur intermittently only under certain
-rditions such as emotional stress are frequently rnissed. The technique
'' continuous ECG recording makes it possible to capture these kinds
arrhythmias. This was introduced by Norman Holter to obtain a
a :-tinuous ECG the electrocardiogram of a subject is recorded during
s ' s normal daily activity by means of a special magnetic tape recorcler.
* --:
tr smallest device of this type can actually be worn in a shirt pocket
il - : allows recordings of the ECG for four hours. other recorders about
- - size of a camera case are worn
rE over the shoulder and can record
f ' i for upto 24 hours. The recorded tape is analyzed using a special
ud
d =:-ning device which plays back the tape at a higher speed than that
':: for recording. In this way a 24 lno.ur record can be reviewed in as
- : as 12 minutes. During the play back the
beat to beat interval of
- -rocardiogram is displayed on a cathode ray tube as a picket fence
'- lattern in which arrhythmic episodes are clearly visible. once such
, risode has been discovered the tape is backed up and srowed down
:tain a normal ECG strip for the time interval during which the
' ',thmias occurred.
St
l
br
to note and. can be automated. It has some disadvantages in that it does
not provide a continuous recording of pressure variations and its practical
th
ria
..p"1io.r rate is limited. Furthermore, only systolic and distolic arterial SO
ate
to proper output. This limits their r-rse to those cases in which the be
inc
condition of patients warrants invasion of the vascular system.
rec
5.4.1. lndirect Measurement
The familiar indirect method of measuring blood press!-rre involves
the Llse of sphygmomanometer and a stethoscope' The
/ur
sphygmomanometer composed of a inflatable pressure crlff and a
,,-,.r.,-.r,v or aneroid barometer to measure the pressure in the cuff' The
cuff has of a rubber bladder inside an inelastic fabric covering that can
yM
$ be rvrappe,:l arouncl the upper arm and fastened with either hooks or
a velcro fastcner. The cuff is inflated manually with a rubber bulb and
deflated s1orr,,ly through a needle valve. A walmounted
sphygmomanometer is shown in figure 5.12 (a). These devices are also
manufactured as portable units for the ease of usage'
ud
St
l
the tiny arterial opening during each systole. This turbulence korotkoff
ria
sounds generated can be heard through a stethoscope placed over the
artery downstream from the cuff of the patient.
A sphygmomanometer and stethoscope method of a blood pressure
:rleasurement. The pressure cuff on the upper arm is first inflated to a
lressure well above the systolic pressure. At this point no sound can be
ieard through the stethoscope which is placed on the brachial artery,
lecause that artery has been collapsed by the pressure of the cuff. When
.re pressure is reduced through needle valve korotkoff sounds begin to
ate
:e heard throu.gh the stethoscope. The pressure of the cuff that is
.::dicated on the manometer when the first korotkoff sound is heard is
:corded as the systolic blood pressure.
100
80
yM
r
o)
Drastolic
E60
E
! Xirr r
ud
t-
200
160
Cuff pressure 3
St
Start of
120 3
deflation
Diastolic
-
(o
l
(b\.
The familiar method of locating the systolic and diastolic pressure DTC
ria
values by listening to korotkoff sounds is called the auscaltory method rfl
of sphygmomanometry which a famolar method locating. las
Thi
5.4.2. Automated Indirect Method 24
Due to the trauma imposed by direct measurement of blood pressure
5.4.
and the lack of a more suitable method for indirect measurement, attempts
have been made to automate the indirect procedure. As a result, a
number of automatic or semiautomatic systems have been developed.
ate
Most devices are of a type that utilizes a pressure transducer
connected to the sphygmomanometer cuff, a microphone placed beneath
the cuff (over the artery) and a standard physiological recording systerc
on which cuff pressure and the Korotkoff sounds are recorded. The trasic
proced.ure parallels the manual method. The pressure in the cuff is
,,| automatically inflated to about 22a rnr..;l of Hg and allowed -to dellate
t,
I
slowly. The microphone picks up korotkoff sounds from the artery
I near the surface, just below the compression cuff. The pressure reading
,t/ at the time of first sound represents the systolic pressure, the diastolic
$;r! pressure is the point on the falling pressure where the last sound is
yM
sensed.
Some of the cornmercially available automatic blood pressure meters
work well when demonstrated on a quiet, healthy subject but fail when
used to measure blood pressure during activity or when used on patients
in circulatory shock. Methods other than detecting korikoff sound utilizing
ultrasonic Doppler method are useful in these situations.
While the clinical diagnostic value of systolic and diastolic blood
pressure has been clearly established, the role of mean arterial pressure
(MAP) as an indication of blood pressure trend has become more widelr-
accepted with the expanded use of direct pressure monitoring using
arterial cannulae with electronic transducers and displays. Most electrical
ud
l
lrogrammed time on a continuous basis and during the normal activities
ria
'l patient. Such machine can measure blood pressure on a continuous
:asis for 100 pre-programmed time alongwith a Holter electrocardiograph.
.:ris way the physician can get information of the patient health on a
--1 hours basis.
5.4.3. Direct Measurement
The blood pressure is measured using one of the following methods:
(i) Percutaneous insertion
ate
ii) Catheterization
:ii) Implantation of a transducer in a vessel or heart.
Figure 5.13, gives a general idea of both the methods. For a
-.::cutaneous insertion a locai anesthetic is injected near the site of
-','asion. The vessel is occluded and a hollow needle is inserted at a
.ght angle toward the vessel. When the needle is in place a catheter is
r through a guide. When the.catheter is in place in the vessel the
-:dle and guide are with drawn. For some measurement a typical type
reedle attached to an air tight tube is used, so that the needle can
yM
'' .eft in the vessel and the blood pressure sensed directly to by attaching
-:ansducer to a tube. Other types have the transducer built into the
: of the catheter.
Superior
Vena Cava
light Pulmonary
Artery
Pulmonary Trunk
Right Otrium
ud
Tricuspid Valve
St
Boslic Vein
l
indicated dilution studies and of vasoactive drugs directly into the heart
ria
and certain vessels. A catheter is a long tube that is introduced into
heart or a major vessel by way of a superficial vein or artery.
A catheter technique of measurement of blood pressure is done in
the following ways. A sterile saline solution is introduced into a catheter
so that the fluid pressure is transmitted to transducers outside the
body. A complete fluid pressure system is set up with provision for
checking against atmospheric pressure and for establishing a reference
point. The frequency response of this system is a combination of the
ate
frequency response of the transducer and fluid column in the catheter.
In the second method the pressure measurements are obtained at the
source. Here the transducer is introduced. into the catheter and pust'ed
to the point at which the pressure is to be measured or the transducer
is mounted at the tip of the catheter. This device is called a catheter Lip
f:/
blood pressure transducer. An unbounded strain gauge or a variable
Tti,
inductance transducer is used for mounting catheter tip blood pressure
transducer. 1
differential transformer. u
(irj A catherterization method involving the placement of the transducer p
through a catheter at the actual site of measurements in the p
bloodstream, i.e., to the aorta or by rnounting the transducer on tl
the tip of catheter. ol
bl
(iu) Implantation technique in which the transducer is more permanentil-
put in the blood vessel or at the heart by surgical methods. SC
sl
ri
:]I
-..1 organs of the body require a71 acTecluate blooct sttpply' infact if the
.rod supply to a pariicular organ is not ad.equate then that particular
' g," not functiott ptop"t5'' The ability to measure blood flow in
^ay
:-.- \'essel that supplies Utood to a particular organ would'
therefore' be
. great help in diagnosing such diseases' It is not very easy to measure
l
lod flow.
ria
Gasinapipeortherateofflowofaliquidisexpressedasthe
lume of the substance that passes through a pipe in a given unit
of
per minute or
.:^re. Flow rates are, therefore, usually expressed in liters
'..[i.meter per minute (cm3/min).
Physically all the blood flow meters currentiy used in clinical
and
.:earch aPPlications are as follow:
liJ Electromagnetic induction
irl Uitrasound transmission or reflection
ate
iiz) Thermal convection
.1,) Radiographic PrinciPle
u) Indicator, i.e., dye or thermal dilution
Magneticandultrasonicblooclflowmetersmeasurethevelocityof
.. e blood stream. Therefore, these transducers are to be placed in exposed
Detection
.-rod vessel, these transducers are mainly used during.-surgery'
flow measurement
,struction of blood vessels where quantitative blood
,:e not required can be done by using ultrasounds'
Segrrents, can be used to the measure of the flow of blood
in the
yM
...,bs-canbeindicatedbyaplethysmographwhichactuailyindicates
,Iume changes in bodY.
5.5.1. Magnetic Blood Flow Meters
When an electric conduction is moved through a magnetic f,reld
a
Jltage is induced in conductor proportional to the velocity
of its motion'
-." Ju.-" principal is applicable when the rnoving conductor is not a
,,':re,butratheracolumnofconductivefluidthatflowsthroughatube
catedirrthemagneticfield.Figure5.l4showshowthisprincipleis
,.sed in magnetic btod flow meters. A permanent magnet
or electromagnet
_ositioned around the blood vessel generates a magnetic field
blood flow. The induced voltage in
_"i."ai."lar to the direction of the
ud
,:iatinum disk thatiouch the wall of the blood vessel. The orihce of the
--robe must fit tightly around the vessel
for proper operation'
l
ria
F
Blood Flow
Fig. 5.14. Magnetic blood flow meter principle TJ
tl
ate
a
flr
of
UI
,|
/,,
yM
Fig.5.15'samplesoflargeandsmallhumandiametersbloodflowprobe
catheter tip transd.ucer used the magnetic blood flow transdllcers
principle. It is essentially turned 'inside out' with the electromagnet
temgiocated inside the catheter, which has the electrodes at the outside'
Catheter transducer can be calibrated in flow units'
ud
problem several different waveforms have been advocated for the magnet - -li
current as shown in figure 5.16. With a sinusoidal magnet current, the
induced voltage is also sinusoidal but is 90" out of phase with the flow
_
\)
signal. With ; suitable circuit, similar to a bridge the induced voltage :ST
St
u" partially balanced. out. with the magnetic current in the form of ':e
"""., wave the induced voltage shall be zero once the spike from the
"polarity
"qrr".L reversal has passed. These spikes are often of extremely high -:lr
ampttlde and the cir-uitry response tends to extend their effect. As the " i:J
Magnet
Current
ii(a))(c)
l
/'^
\_tu_,
ria
Fi9.5.16. Waveforms used in magnetic blood flow meters and error signals induced
by the current: (a) sine wave; (b) square wave; (c) trapezoidal wave
Figure 5.17 shows the block diagram of a magnetic blood flow meter.
. he oscillator which drives the magnet and provides a centrol signal for
-re gate operates at a frequency of between 60 and 4OO Hz. The use of
ate
,.- gated detector made the polarity of the output signal reverse when the
'.ow direction reverses. The mean or average flow can be derived by use
: a low pass filter. The frequency response of this type of system is
-sually high enough to allow the recording of the flow pulses.
yM
Pulse Average
o.'iI#'
Cardiovascular Measurements 95
l
downstream sensors is a measure of the blood velocity. If called a
thermostromuhr. Thermal convection methods for blood flow
ria
determination have ceased to exist.
5.5.4. Blood Flow Determination by Radiographic Method
By the injection of a contrast medium into blood vessel, i.e., arr
iodated organic compound the circulation pattern can be locally visible
rvhich is not normally visible on an X-ray image because it has about
the same radio density as the surrounding tissue. On a sequential record
of the X-ray image, either photographic or on a videotape recording, the
ate
progress of the constant medium can be followed, obstructions can be
detected and the blood flow in certain blood vessels can be estimated.
Ihe techniqtle, known as cine'or video angiography can be used to
assess the extent of damage after heart attack or a stroke.
The injection of a radioactive isotope into the blood circulation, which
allows the detection of vascular obstruction i.9., in the lung with an
-mage device for nuclear radiation such as a scanner or gamma camera.
Measuring differences in the skin temperature caused by the reduced
:irculation the vascular obstructions in the lower extremities can
yM
sometimes be directed.
5.5.5. Measurement by Indicator Dilution Methods
This method really measures the blood flow and not the blood
'elocity. In principle any substance can be used as an indicator if it
::rixes readily with blood and its concentration in the blood can be easily
letermined after mixing. The substance must be stable but should not
re retained by the body and side effects must not exist.
Cardiogram an indocyanine dye, used in a isotonic solution was long
:avoured as an indicator. Its concentration was determined by measuring
he light absorption with a densitometer (colorimeter). Radioactive isotopes
,-.ave also been employed for the purpose. The indicator most
ud
l
ria
,{
4:
'llit
tl
ate
Fig. 5.19. Flow measurement by indication dilution methods, principle.
The indicator is injected at time t = i
yM
MEASUREMENT OF HEART SOUND
The heart sound listen by the physician by putting his ear near the
chest of the patient. This is taken over by the stethoscope, which is a
device that carriers sound ener5/ from the chest of the patient to the ear
of the physician via a column of the air. There are many forms of
stethoscope but the familiar conhguration has two earpieced connected
to a common bell of chest piece. The system is strictly acoustical. Only
a small portion of energz of the heart is in audible frequency range.
A graphic record of heart sound is called phonocardiogram is very
successful. The instrument for producing this recording is called a
phonocardiograph. A pressures, ECG transis and heart sound over time
ud
Cardiovascular Measurements 97
40
-o)
l
E
E
ria
o
f
frro
o-
t(o
o
-c
.9
cEN
14Or
ate
Maximum
120 ejection
6
I
E 100
tr
E.^
q
o
o60
E
E
(u
0)
f,40
.c
.9)
yM
G
20
Heart
sounds
, 150
4: rzo
E* so
g5 60
5E 300
ud
02 08
Time (s)
St
Fig. 5.20. Pressures ECG trancings, and hear shown opver time
Multichannel physiological recording systems of the phonocardiogram
:: one of the measurement is available. With a microphone amplifier
::-d a pen recorder to record upto 2OO Hz of frequency.
Page No. 96 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
digital computer'with a high speed analog to digital conversion capability
and some form of Fourier transform software is required.
ria
Phonocardiogram are designed to be placed on the chest over the
heart using microphone. Heart sounds sometimes measured from other
points, for this purpose, special microphone transducers are placed at
the catheter to pick up heart sounds from within the heart chambers or
from the major blood vessels, near the heart. Frequency response
requirement of these microphones are abor.rt the same as for cl
phonocardiogra ph microphones.
ct
The apex cardiograph and the vibrocardiograph which measure the
ate
ch
vibrocardiogram and apex cardiogram respectively also use microphones pr
as transducers. But, these measurements involve the low frecluency CU
vibrations of the heart against the chest wall, hence, the measurement ab
is normally one cf the displacement of force rather than sound. Thus the ve
microphones used must be a good transdr,rcer of force with suitable low
w1
frequency coupling from the chest wall to the microphone transducer.
be
For the apex cardiogram, the microphone must be coupled to a point
between the ribs. Good result for this purpose can be achieved.
Using the apex cardiogram and the vibrocardiogram do not conlain
the high frequency components of the heart sounds, these signals can
yM
be handled by the same type of amplifiers and recorders as the
electrocardiogram. Often these signals are recorded alongwith channel of
ECG data to maintain time reference. In this case one channel of a
multichannel trCG recorder.
The Korokoff sounds can be recorded used from a partiallv occluded
arlery.a microphone is usually placed beneath occueing cuff or over the
artery immediately downstream from the cuff. The waveform and frequency
content of these sound are not as important as the simple identification
of their pressure, so these sounds generally do not require high frequency slol
response specified for the phonocardiogram. Automated indirect- ACC
measurement of blood pressure circuitry for these is same. dur
ud
PLETHYSMOGRAPHY
The measurement of blood flow is the measurement of volume changes
in any part of the body which result from the pulsations of blood occurring
with each heartbeat. These measurements are useful in the diagnosis of
arterial obstructions as well as pulse-wave velocity measurements.
Instruments measuring volume changes or providing outputs that can
St
Cardiovascular Measurements gg
l
To
ria
Recorder
Airtight Seat
ate
pressure is calibrated by use of a cali line
cuff which is ptacea sngttty ,p"tr"ril'
above venous pressure, arterial blood ; ,11:
*'enous brood cannot leave. As a , ,fr"
result the rimb i.r"...s.s its vorume
*'ith each heartbeat by the volume of the blood
beat' The output trace of measurement ..rt..irg during that
is shown in figure 5.22.
yM
the
the
off
ud
SUMMARY
Biomedical instrumentation speciarly for
cardiovascurar system, herped
a lot in reducing untimely death iue
to heart failures.
St
l
b100d volume is in the veins about200k of the blood is in arteries and
remaining in caPalaries.
ria
3. Electrocardiography: The electrocarcliography is used clinically in
diagnosing,..io,"diseasesandconditionsassociatedwiththeheart.
tn"trregraphicalrepresentationofECGthePwaverepresents
depolarizati.on of the artrial musculature' The QRS complex is the
combinedresultoftherepolarizationoftheateriaandthe
repolarization of the ventricles which occur almost simultaneously'
The T wave is the wave of ventricular repolarization. In diagnosis
of
of beats per
heart the heart rate should be in the range 60-100
ate
minute, the heart rate slower than this is called bradycardia and
higher rate as tachycardia. Physician then see if the cycles are evenly
sp"aced. If the cycles
- are not evenly spaced then the condition is
called arr then O'2 sec' it can suggest
blockade idual ECG remains fairlY'
,t,
constant instrument used to obtain
r,
{l
t;
electrocardiogram is called an electrocardiograph'
dr In biomedical electronics we have to measure bio-electric potentials'
fr
t( For this purpose normal ampliher where the reference is through
ground of tn" power supply ari not suitable. In this case a differential
yM
\
Implifier witkr a frigh input gain and high common mode rejection
ratio of the order of 1O,OO,00O : 1 are used'
I
I
thesurfaceofthebody'Theelectrodesappliedtothebodyarethe
named as RA, LA, RL, Ll and c. The wires which comes from
electrodes to the ECG machines are called leads. The four electrodes
except electrode RL (right leg) which is ground are used for the
by
.".oidi.rg of electrocr.riiog."-. The other system introduced are
Einthroven may be seen in frgure 5'6' The arrangement of leads
suchthatinatlthepositionstheRwaveofQRSispositive. .T
In the ECG recorder the leads from the patient are connected to the
ud
of ir
ECG recorder through a selector switch. A standardization voltage t
paper
1 mV is used for calibration of the recorder. The recording L
used is a heat sensitive paper where the stylus is electrically heated f(
For recording.
is
Normally, electro cardiograms are recorded at a PaPer sPeed of
25 mm/sec but faster sPeed of 50 mm/sec is also available. The
C
Cardiovascular Measurements
101
are^used to- determine several
LT":ll,:"",.i#l:"1,^.:s
damages is human toay. ecC-"".i'I,*"'ru,ne
severat defects and
and
:tect hypertrophy and arterial
enlargement. ,tJ,,,^h+ri^^r^-
:l..ll?":..1j::d;il;il'Jff
:;ilT""f, :::"?lli:X;i::l#
l
:HH1Tl;"*#Ii:,gH1;;+:;;.:"Til,1X8::i,H":'# :J,j3l,i:,."?,,, clinical
:::1##,:orheart""a-pCil;T&;,,,ffi
ria
applications.
+. Blood pressure M t:
indication of sever
di
patient from severe
n
measured by means of
sphygmomanometer. There
ar
measurement one is indirect
and
of blood pressure.
ate
r In the indirect method the measur
which consists of a cuff *friJ
yM
d Cardiac. Output: The normally
the following types:
(zJ Erectromagnetic induction
(izJ Ultrasound transmission
or reflection.
(ilzJ Thermal convection
(iu) Radiographic principle
(u) Indicator dilution
The magnetic blood flow
meter are normally used by
ud
l
of heart sound.
The high frequency sound from heart is known as murmurs indicate
ria
, po""ibl" heart disease. For this reason a spectral analysis of heart
sound.s can provide a useful diagnostic tool for diagnosis of normal
and abnormal heart.
g. Plethysmography: Plethysmography is used for the measurement of
volume changes in any part of the body that result from the pulsations
of blood occurring with each heart beat, Such measurements are
useful in the diagnosis of arterial obstructions as well as pulse wave
ate
velocity measurement.
The plethysmograph consists of a rigid chamber placed over the limb
in which the volume changes are to be measured'
\
,ij|
txerciae,t
(
l:, 5.1. wirat is electrocardiography? Discuss various characteristic featr-lres of (
r$
trCG amplifiers. (UPTU 20031
(
Jr to the body of the
il S 2. Discuss about the electrodes and leads that are fixed
patient in order to record an electrocardiogram' (UPTU' 2OO3t e
yM
[n 5.3. i)iscr-t: ' 1-wo commonly used ECG recorders briefly' (UPTU' 2OO3' c
5.4. I{rrrr. :an electrocardiography be used for stress testing? (UPTU' 2003 6
5.5. Djo^,.rss an automated indirect method of blood pressure measurement' 6
(UPTU, 200s 6
5.6. Explain the ultra-sonic method of blooci flow measurement.
(UPTU, 2003
5.7. Explain the trCG recorders, (r) three channel, (ir') vector cardiograph'
(UPTU, 200/
I
5.g. Explain briefly the ECG system used for stress testing. (UPTU' 2004 .1e
5.9. trxplain a method of heart sound measurement' (UPTU' 2O0t -j lul
5.10. Explain main parts of electrocarcliogram. How can you determine the fse
PPTU, MQP '
ud
heart rate? I
5.1 1. Discuss measurement of blood pressure and possible error due to traumz _ tcu
or other physiological effect on patient. (UPTU' MQP '
:- a]
5.72. Describe the three methods used to measure the blood pressure. r:e(
(UPTU, MQP : -
T
5.13. What is the importance of blood flow? Discuss the biomedical instrumen:s : -)fr
that are used to measure the blood flow' (UPTU' MQP )t
. -..clt
5.14. Draw an electrocardiogram (in lead II), labelling the critical features'"
:S
include typical amplitudes and time interval for a nominal person. Expl
St
l
ria
Patient Care and Monitoring
.-.
6"1.
6.2.
6.3.
6.4.
fnside this ehapter
l
o
leads to rendering better service to a large number of patients, able to
react promptly and properly to an emergency situation. Such a capability
ria
provides an immediate alarm in the event of certain abnormalities. The
monitoring equipment makes it possible to call a physician or nurse in
time to administer emergency aid before permanent damage can occur.
The availability of electrocardiograrn record just prior to, during, after
the onset of cardiac difficulty, the prompt monitoring and warning system
enables the physician to give the patient the correct drug rapidly. In
many cases, their process can b,e automated. There are differences of
opinions about the physiologica.l parameters to be measured among
ate
physicians. The monitoring of s,everal parameters are very expensive,
therefore, it is necessary to choose only essential parameters. However,
continuous monitoring of heart tJerough electrocardiogram is quite normal
in any intensive care unit. Temperature measurement is quite frequent.
There are several parameters sr,rch as blood pressure may be measured
not so frequently. However, if ccrntinuous measurement of blood pressure
is the need, it requires catheterization of the patient which requires
experience of catheterization, arrd also in many cases may affect condition
of the patient. This is also painful to the patient.
yM
The development of electrir: equipments which are capable of reliable
measurement and display, c:oncept of intensive care-monitoring has
become feasible. These unitsr are installed along 'the bed side of the
patient. The facilities inch.rde electrocardiogram, heart rate and
informations from bedside in. all other monitored parameters.
The basic elements of in1:ensive care monitoring unit are: JD
(r) Skin electrodes to pick'up ECG potentials. -.1 c
(iz) Amplification unit for r:lectrocardiograph. : ata
(rfl CRT display for observation of ECG waveforms. The central nurses !::ltr
station normally can lhave CRT display of several patients on the
same screen. i
ud
(lu) A rate meter to indicate heart beat, it can have continuous indicatior:
;
with audible beep or flashing light at each heart beat. =:tl
(u) An alarm system is actuated by the rate meter to alert the nurse.
;::a
rl
(rri) A direct wired-up derrice for electrocardiograph.
(uil A memory tape to rer:ord the playback of ECG for 15 to 6O sec.
(uiiz) Additional alarm syst,ern triggered by ECG parameters.
(rx) Electrical circuit to indircate that electrode connections have become
disconnected which rrLe5r be due to mechanical failure.
St
l
ria
Measuring
Devices and its
Analog lnteface
Display
ate
Display Digital
Alarm etc.
fuD
I-other -_l
Converter I ortprt I
l
6
ria
,l
tl
/l ,'a E
tt.-
I t a-,'----r' e(
---/ \' ar
Fig. 6.2. ECG Pattern made of dots It
in which
The brightening signals are produced from a digital memory
several seclonds ol da-ta from each channel of the patient monitor are
tt
ate
stored.
oneoftheimportantfeatureofanypatient-monitoringsystemisits
particular
th
ability to display the physiological waveforms or condition of
a
orgat. The principat display devices are th hr
small single or dual channel display at th ar
display monitors for various requirements io
tror"
,(t'.
Biside monitors are available in a variety of conhgurations importanr
cf
t,, d ure gned to monitor different T}
.-{,, p as and heart rate' etc' One s"rch rf
,c: I
EEEE
lsolation rate ::.e
.--a_
F*"t"s'f
lk
ud
rm
Memory L
Hold
Cr-rc
ilE-t l
L.o.T. br
l
6.3. DIAGNOSIS, CALIBRATION AND REPAIRABILITY OF PATIENT.
ria
MONITORING EQUIPMENT
:ngineers and technicians need to diagnose the problems
of monitoring
:luipments. It is essential that equipments are operational and calibrated
.:curatel5r. Many electronic units are available for calibration purposes.
can have built in calibration leature, i.e., ECG may have 1 mV
-.libration voltage avnilability.
Ntlany medium units have built in diagnostic feature to trouble shoot
ate
:-e equipmenr malfunctions. Generally these are manufactured such
.^at ease of replacement or repair or both exist.
The spread of medical instruments with high degree of complexity
..s created a great demand for effective and efficient trouble shooting
:--d maintenance. The effective methods of maintenance have been evolved
meet the challenge of complexity. Depending on the conceived scope
'lhe
maintenance function, needs very because of the technical realities.
-.ere are several major activities involved in the process of installation
a large expensive biomedical instrumentation such as X-ray, CT scan,
lRI, etc. The installation and cummissining must be well planned with
yM
.:h detail. Plan some trials, just after installation. Select and train
::rators of the equipments and setups. some basic trouble shooting
-,C maintenance training is essential to avoid costly long
time
-.akdowns.
The manuals must be obtained for installation, operation, and
-:rntenance, Critical spares may be procured if backup by supplier is
,:d to get Potential maintenance points:
il Environment conditions of the instrumentation would generarly be
good, however, temperature, dust, humidity should be in tolerance
limit.
:N No heavy machinery should be around like presses, compressors
ud
-aintenaflce are:
:r Multimeter
:rl Oscilloscope
:t Temperature controlled soldering equipments
, t Extender cards and spares
l
reliability. Modular concept in the system design has further strengthened dr
ria
the hands of maintenance engineer
The number of printed circuit board modules have reduced Str
ate
Real time diagnostic are active during system usage: Though real
time diagnostic gives an indication of the problem, special skill is still
required to prqbe further and findout the ultimate caurse.
There are some offline diagnostics which guide the maintenance
engineer through a step-by-step process analysis of the instrumentation
.ai"
system. The off-line diagnostic which can be used to call one programme
lr (i
lr at a time, like:
fr CPU diagnostics
- Memory diagnostics
- CRT diagnostics 64
yM
,il
- D/A and A/D diagnostics
- I/O diagnostics -re
:ht
- Remote diagnostics involve the use of the phone data. A link is
64..
established between the computer in the instrumentation system and to
the main-computer in the hospital. It performs both static and dynamic
tests. This is an effective tool for solving even intermittent problems. :-ar
This is used in preventive maintenance also. I
Vibration and Oxidation: The biomedical instrumentation suffer when ::lv
subjected to excessive vibration: :,]II
(zJ Friction connections (circuit board socket or piug socket) can move
ud
V .',-e1
vibration-induced movement. A contact cleaner and deoxidation treatment
helps. Erasers should not be used to clean connector pins because thel- ' . :::1
are likely to abrade away the thin silver or gold plating, thus, ruining
the conductive surface. f43,
Power-supply conditioning: The most effective action to ensure
instrumentation system reliability is to protect them with new generatior- I - : t''
Page No. 107 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
109 FunCamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
l
levices, are now available.
Even if power supplied to the hospital is relatively clean, voltage
ria
rcikes and other transients are generated within the hospital itself as a
:esult of operating motors; fluorescent lights, solenoids, SCRs, switching
:rcuits, etc. As these are switched on and off, surges or spikes are
-:ansmitted to power or signal lines. If these transients get into
-:mputerized equipment, they may be misinterpreted as digital commands
: other information, therefore, must be avoided. The various devices
: :e:
ate
ll Inductiue-capacitiue filters: Reduction of radio frequency noise of a
known bandwidth but do not clamp fast transients.
iirl Resis/once-capacitance filters: Medium speed and capability, but
like inductive capacitive filters, don't clamp fast transients.
iil Metal-oxide Vaistor (MOV): Suppressor have semifast response
capability.
iu) Isolation transformer: The main equipments are given supply through
isolation transformer which separates circuits.
=patible.
t rt.2. Arterial Diagnostic Unit (ADU)
It provides automated pressure-cuff inflation for rapidly determining
l,-=:nental pressures and post-exercise pressure trends in non-invasive
:*:--pheral arterial evaluations. The strip chart is used for recording
i :pler-flow pulse waveforms, ECG traces and other physiological
St
l
I
units capable
monitored continuously. Geieralty these are computerized
ria
ofmonitoringallthevariablesusuallynecessaryinthecathlab.It
and ECG' Multiple t
includes cardiovascular pressures, cardiac output' (
strip charts, ar-rd
channel of analog data can be recorded on continuous t
computer generated rePorts can
*"r"fot-". Calculated resuits, d (
ate
bCG *u.r.forms are also disPlaYed
or call any data on screen for instant display'
6.5. oRGANIZATIoNoFTHEHoSPITALFoRPATIENT.CARE
MONITORING
organtzation
The technical personnel must be farniliar with the hospital
suchaswhichdiagnosticequipmentsareavailableinwhatpartofthe lines:
rr""pit"r. Generally-equipmenti are divided, on the following
(if Surgical equiPments
yM
These are placed in the operating room 'uvhere surgery
is actually
performed.
(ii) Non-surgical equiPments
The monitoring equipments made available in operation various
room are
d' arterial blood pressures' ECG' EEG'
heart like
respir ' It may also have emergency equipments
ers, stimulation equipments' etc'
dehbr
The in ich is generally post surgical follow-
upcontaiS,nurse,scentralcontrolunitsto
monitor p uslY'
ud
(CCU) and
Heart-attack patients are placed in coronary care-unit units ma]'
sometimes called cardiac carelunit (CCU). The
monitoring
havebloodpressure,heartrateandECGmeasurementequipments.
ediate coronarl'-
After some recovery CCU patient may mo like telemetq''
c..e unlt (ICCU). This unit may have
ambul atient has hear:
equipments to monitor patients from
attackathome,mobileemergencycareunitCoruesintoservice.These
may have cardi y resuscitation technique experts rn'ith
similar to the ones used in the intensive
St
equipments and
care units of the
PAGEMAKERS
Therhythmicactionoftheheartisduetoregularrecurringactlc: at the sinitorj
potentials originating at natural card.iac pacemaker located
Page No. 109 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
(SA) node. Heart block occurs whenever the conduction fails to transmit
the pacing impulses from artria to the ventricles properly. In such cases,
an artifrcial method of pacing is generally required to ensure the heart
l
beats.
A device capable of creating artificiar pacing impulses and delivering
ria
them to the heart is known as pacemaker system or just pacemaker. Ii
contains pulse generator and suitable electrodes. The pacemakers are of
two types;
(if Internal pacemakers
ate
yM
(a) Mycardial generator implanted in abdomen
--t
\_,,
ud
l
(ii) External pacemakers 6
ria
These are used on patients with temporary heart irregularities. This A,
may be due to coronary patient and heart blocks. This may also be used p(
in post operative periods after cardiac surgery. External pacemakers hr
include pulse generators located outside body which are normally ve
connected through the wires introduced into right ventricle via a cardiac th
catheter. The portable pulse generator is hangs on the body fixed with AC
some straps. sy
The pacing technr'ques employed are as follows:
ate
1S
Pacing Modes CO
tw
AS
Competitive
vel
0. no
fib:
,.t atr
F Ventricular programmed Arterial programmed the
for use in demand or
stand by mode
lrrf
yM
{fi fibr
rnt
Asynchronous mol
Demand Stand by Synchronized fixed rate for
B-waveinhibited R-wave P-wave of ECG elderly people
triggered hav
app
The block diagram of various functions of the units are as follows: suff
StlIT
:he
subr
=ho<
::le
ud
:-n e
-r tl
:ntii
:ehb
-=ad
:nC
h
::teI
St
Implanted units have lithium-iodine battery which last for 5 years. ,rnn
The sources of electromagnetic ener$/ such as microwave ovens a_ffect
t cal
----:ou
implanted or external pacemakers, i.e., patients are advised to keep
away from sources of electrical interference such as microwave ovens. ': SS I
l
DEFIBRILLATORS
ria
.\ction of the heart muscle fibers if precisely synchronized leads to proper
cerformance of heart in its pumping function. The two chambers of the
reart contract together and pump blood through the two atrioventricular
,.-alues into the ventricles due to rapid spread of action potentials over
:he surface of the atria. The ventricular muscles are synchronously
activated to pump blood through the pulmonary and systemic circulatory
s\.stems. The condition under which the necessary synchronism is lost
-s known as fibrillation. During this period, the normal rhythmic
ate
:ontractions of either the atria or the ventricles become rapid irregular
:*,itching of the muscular wall. Fibrillation of artrial muscles is known
.s arterial frbrillation, whereas fibrillation of the ventricles is called
',.entricular fibrillation. Atrial hbrillation leads to irregular rhythm and
:on-synchronized bombardment of electrical stimulation from the
:-crillating atria. Most the blood flow into the ventricles occurs before
.:rial contraction, therefore, blood for the ventricles to pump is still
.rere. The sensation generated by the fibrillating atria and subsequent
-egular ventricular action is quite painful for the patent. Ventricular
' orillation leads to ventricles inability to pump blood and if not corrected
yM
:- time can cause death within few minutes. Such patients need careful
:-onitoring of cardiac.
Heart massage (a mechanical method) for defibrillation of patients
-:r,e been quite common. However, most successful method is the
.:plication of an electric shock to the area of'the heart. In this case
i:tficient current is applied for a brief period and then released. It
r:::nulates all musculature of the heart simultaneously which makes all
':-e heart muscles fibers to enter refractory periods together and
-: csequently normal heart action may start. The duration of the electrical
i-.rrck is 0.25 sec to 1 sec at 50 Hz ac at an intensity of about 5 A to
-: chest of the patient through appropriate electrodes. This method of
ud
Charge..-
l
ria
Fig. 6.5. Circuit of dc defibriilator var
disr
The electrical eners/ discharged by the capacitor may vary between
ate
knc
100 to 400 W-sec or ioules anci duration of the effective period of
diar
discharge may be about 5 m sec. The energz delivered is as shown in
-{ p,
figure 6.6. The plot of current Vs time has peak value of current of jelly
20 A. The wave is essentially monophasic as most of its excursion is and
above baseline.
rl
l, The peak voltages may be as high as 6000 V which endanger the
swit
myocardium and the chest walls. This risk can be reduced by increasing
It waveform duration to 10 m sec with dual peak'ulraveform as shown in
figure 6.7. --oul
1! :efo
yM
h 20
6 :iscl
q)
g_ 16
-npl,
E :efib
(E
4.10u
=12
C
I t
38 =:rh]
q)
:o- --- su
4
o_- ::cm
:ust
:::SUl
-
-- \rel
ud
oo 1200 Pr
3 goo
:-schr
0)
o)
:-::plil
E
o
600 :,. Che
D 300 _-. _tmr
.o :=:lbri
o
o-
Fis
St
levels 50 W sec to 2OO W sec. The voltage can be further lowered b1- Thr
truncated waveform as shown in figure 6.8. :'. Q lr
1200
t
o 900
o)
=o
l
600
D
.9 300
ria
a.
o_
0 5 10 15
Time (milliseconds)
Fig. 6.8. Truncated dc defibrillator discharge waveform
The amplitude of this waveform is nearly constant, but duration is
'aried to make up the amount of energz required. A large current
:ischarge is achieved-through the skin electrodes. These electrod.es are
ate
':nown as paddles which are having metal disks of 8 to 10 cms in
-:ameter for external use, but for internal use smaller paddles are used.
-. pair of electrodes is press fixed against the patient's chest. conductive
:lly or a saline-soacked gauze pad is applied between each paddle surface
.:-ld the skin to prevent burning.
special insulated handles are used to avoid. electric shock. Thumb
;'.,.-itch if used in handles is useful to control discharge.
The methods of discharge are programmable and include watt-sec. or
. , ule meter to indicate the amount of energz stored in the capacitor
- =fore discharge. There is some eners/ loss and all energr is not
yM
:-scharged. Due to large amount of eners/ release in discharge, an
-olanted pacemaker pulse generator located immediately beneath a
:':-rbrillator paddle may be damaged during discharge, therefore, care
, ruld be taken in such cases.
Defibrillators are also helpful to convert other potentially dangerous
"--::ythmias to the manageable case and this is known as cardioversion.
- such cases, to avoid the possibility of ventricular fibrillation resulting
: :r the application of the dc pulse in the cardioversion, the discharge
r -st be synchronized with the electrocardiogram. The synchronization
-'- : lres safety during the heart's vulnerable period.
Heart is succeptible
'r ','entricular fibrillation by the introduction of artificial stimuli, during
ud
"P :Cer with digital display of energr and heart rate. This operates on
?* - -rgeable batteries and as such uses dc-dc converter for stepping up
'h' tltage required for charging the storage capacitor.
-:-e maximum ener$/ devered is about 300 watts delivered into
;r -- road which is equivalent to about 400 watts of stored ener$/.
Page No. 114 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
116 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
l
ria
I
:(
ate
r
i
:I
li
a
,!l,l
-D
!ir o.
y, Fig. 6.9. Latest defibrillator
w
"21 Figure 6.10 shows electrodes used in cardiac defibrillation. A spoon- Si
yM
q; shaped internal electrode is shown which is applied directly to the heart lr
when it is surgically exposed. It consists of the metal electrode itself 1o
having spoon-shape. Side by side a paddle-type electrode is shown which EC
is applied against the anterior chest wall. ar
L ter
I
\
r.
v
ud
(r
Eleckode
l1
\\
Control
D
Switch
;
lnsulated
Handles
l
St
.a
li
1. IntensiveCare Monitoring: Critical patients such as pre-heart attaclc ::]
post-heart attack and post-surgical operation require continuous .-::
l
ria
. Patient Monitoring Displays: Various types of CRT display_
conventional bouncing barl and non-fade types, other anarog and
digital display devices are used in patient health care.
' Other Instruments for Mo q,,--,^^, equipments'
arterial diagnostic units and ^l:r:1
equtpments for patient
parameter monitoring inclu
ate
yM
ing patients: Surgical monitoring
it, catheterization lab equipments
for monitoring of patients.
'
i ircide,J
a) Pacemakers
St
l
6.13.
rgery, and dia[nostics' Specify all the-
incl-uding the possibility of
ria
necessary,
emergencles.
aaa
t(
F'l
s
q
ate \
1
yM
1
l
ud
St
l
ria
Measurements in The
ate
Respiration System
l
carried by the lungs and distributed among the various cells of the body
by the blood circulation system, which also returns the carbon dioxide
ria
to the lungs. This whole process of inspiring, expiring air, exchange of
gases, distribution of oxygen to the cells and collection of CO, from the
cells form pulmonary function. Pulmonary function test is measuring
the various components of the process are called.
Complete measurement cannot be done by a pulmonary test. The
pulmonary tests are divided into two categories-the Iirst no single
laboratory is to measure the mechanics of brea[hing and physical
ate
characteristics of the lungs, the second category is involved with diffusion
of gases in the lungs, the collection of carbon dioxide and the distribution
of oxygen.
Yr,
The nasal cavities, larynx, trachea, bronchi and bronchioles as shown in
ls, figure 7 .1 are the body parts through which air enters the lungs through
Jr the air passage which include.
The lungs are like elastic bags locaterd in a closed cavity called
q
yM
thoracic cavity. The right lung consists of tttree lobes, i.e., upper, middle
and lower and left lung has two lobes up[)er and lower.
The larynx, known as the troice box', is connected to bronchi through
the trachea sometime called the windpipe. Whenever a person swallows
the food and liquids are directed to the esophagus that is connected to
stomach rather than into the larynx and trachea, the laynx hits epiglottis.
a valve that closes.
The trachea is about 1.5 to 2.5 cm in diameter and approximatelv
11 cm long, extending from the larynx to the upper boundary of the
chest. Here it is divided into the right an<I left main stem bronchi. Each
bronchus enters into the corresponding lung and divides like the limbs
of a tree into smaller branches. The branch diameter reduces to about
ud
0.1 cm, the air-conducting tubes are called bronchioles. As they continue
to decrease in size to about 0.05 cm in diameter, they form the termina.I
bronchioles, which branch again into the respiratory bronchioles, where
some alveoli are attached as small air sacs in the walls of the lungs.
After some additional branching, these z:-ir sacs increase in number-
becoming the pulmonary alveoli. The alve<tli are each about O.O2 crn in
diameter. According to rough estimate some 300 million alveoli are found
St
l
ria
Pharynx
Entrance of air
Gullet or esophagus
Larynx
Windpipe or lrachea
r eural cavity
Righl
ate Pleura covering the lung
Alveoli
Space occupied
by heart
Ci
Smooth h,
Muscle tt
l
Alveolar di
ria
Capailary Pulmonary
CA
Network Venule
of
Th
atr
ate
Alveolar Capulaves Th
duct diz
IT1L
Alveo ar
be
Sac
hal
Fi1.7.2. Alveoli and capillary network per
Accomplishment breathing by musculature that literally changes the of1
volume of the thoracic cavity and in doing so creates negative and anc
positive pressures that move air into and out of the lungs. Two sets of :nsl
muscles are involved: those in and near the diaphragm that causes the anc
yM
diaphragm to move up and down, changing the size of the thoracic 7.2.
cavity in the vertical direction, and those that move the rib cage up and
down to change the lateral diameter of thorax.
A special dome or bell shaped muscle, i.e., the diaphragm is located --rnl
at the bottom of the thoracic cavity, which when pulls downward to :Il 1
enlarge the thorax. This action is the principa-l force involved in inspiration aa:
or inhaling. At the same time as the diaphragm moves downward, a
group of external intercostal muscles lifts the rib cage and sternum' Due :9,
to the shape of the rib cage, this lifting action also increases the effective
diameter of the thoracic cavity. The resultant increase in thoracic volume -:fS
creates a negative pressure (vacuum) in the thorax. Since the thorax is :SP
ud
a closed chamber and the only opening to the outside is from the inside 1
of the lungs, the negative pressure is relieved by air entering the lungs. , rIL
The internal pressure of air in the lungs, which is greater than the : '-Dlr
pressure in the thorax outside the lungs. expands the lungs, i.e., passive- T
On release of the inspiratory muscles, the elasticity of the lungs anc ,: th
rib cage combine with the tone of diaphragm, reduces the volume oI T
thorax, thereby developing a positive pressure that forces air out of the :-: e:
lungs. In forced expiration a set of abdominal muscles pushes
St
.--- C
the diaphragm upward very powerfully while the internal intercosta- -:-:aS
muscles pull the rib cage downward and forces air out by applying tht ,-- s p1l
pressure against the lungs. T]
Normal inspiration the pressure inside the lungss is about - 3 mr -:.gs
of Hg, whereas during expiration the pressure becomes about +3 m= ::AC
Hg. The ability of the lungs and thorax to expand during breathing :s '::l ,
l
The interchange of the oxygen from the lungs to the blood and the
diffusion of carbon dioxide from the blood to the lrrrg. takes place in the
ria
capillary surfaces of the alveoli, The alveolar surface area is about Bo m2
cf which more than three fourths is capillary surface.
- he ability of a person to bring air into his rungs from the outside
,tmosphere and to exhaust air from the lungs the mechanics of breathing.
ate
- nis abili[z is affected by the various components of air passages the
::aphragm and associated muscles, the rib cage and associated
:--usculature and the characteristics of the lungs themselves. Tests can
:: performed to assess each of these factors, but no single measurement
--as been devised that can adequately and completely
evaluate the
::rformance of the breathing mechanism. This section rlescribes a number
: the most prominent measurements and tests that are used clinically
,::d in research in connection with the mechanics of breathing. The
:'.strumentation required for these tests and measurements is d.escribed
.:--d considered.
yM
- 2.1. Lung Volumes and Gapacities
In the basic pulmonary tests are those designed for determination of
-::g volumes and capacities. These parameters, which are a function of
. -- :ndividual physical characteristics and the condition of his breathing
- -:hanism, are given in figure 7.3.
The tidal uolume (TV), i.e., normal depth of breathing, is the volume
"as inspired or expired during each normal quite respiration cycle.
Inspiratory reserue uolume (IRV) is that extra volume of gas that a
i*:son can inspire with maximum effort after reaching the normal end
-,::ratory level reached at the end of a normal quite inspiration.
ud
-he expiratory reserue uolume (ERV) is that extra voiume of gas that
. -- ce expired with maximum effort beyond the expiratory level. The end
"' : -- atory level
is the level reached at the end of a normal, quite expiration.
-'te residual ualume (RV) is the volume of gas remaining in the lungs
, ' .: end of a maximal expiration.
- ee vc or uirtua.l capacitg is the maximum volume of gas that can
r' :i.pelled from the lungs by forceful effort after a maximal inspiration
.L: - :he residual volume. This is measured independent of time of
St
l
in the lungs at the end of expiratory level. It is the sum of residual
ria
volume and the expiratory reserve volume.
The FRC can also be calculated as the total lung capacity minus the
inspiratory capacity and is also considered base line from which other
volume and capacities are determined. The FRC is considered to be more
stable than the end inspiratory level.
Several dynamic measures are important because breathing is a
dynamic process and the rate at which gases can be exchanged with the
blood is a direct function of the rate at which it can be inspired or
ate
expired.
The net measure of output of the respiratory system is the respiratory
minute volume. This is a measure of the amount of air inspired during
one minute at rest. It is obtained by multiplying the tidal volume with
.ti number of respiratory cycles per minute.
.ari
Several forced breathing tests are used to assess the muscle power
l' ,',1
I'i required with breathing and the resistance of the airways. Forced uital
I
y'l
capacitg (FVC), which is really a vital capacity and measurements are
taken as quickly as possible. As the name suggests the FVC is the total
amount of air that can forcibly be expired as quickly as possible after
yM
\ taking the deepest possible breath. If the measurement is made with
respect to the time for the process, it is called a timed vital capacity
measurement. A measure of the maximum amount of gas that can be
expelled in a given number of seconds is called the forced expiratory
uolume (FEV). This is usually given with a subscript indicating the number
of seconds over which the measurement is made. For example FEV,
indicates the amount of air that can be blown out in 1 sec and following
a maximum inspiration, while FEV. is the maximum amount of air that
can be expired in 3 seconds. FEV is sometimes given as a percentage of
the forced vital capacity.
The forced vital capacity measurements are many time encumbered
ud
F @ o
o co) E
l
f
Jo
ol
o
o)
t
I
ria
co
co
UJE
q)
(,)
c) J
o_
o E>
E fiE
(6
'd_
x
tJJ
uorlelrdsul
uorletrdx3
ate
() O
(E
TL
a
E .o
.=
E. o
TU E (U
o-
(U
o
c
(U
a
o
E
yM
f
o)
c
J=
ort
i-
0
II
_E-" I:
eEH Fa*
> E-o
trRH
E^
)ao\
869
ud
N(v
tr
ooq
6(o
(r) E5$
o 8;e E.
>s8 >^aY
,.Fg
St
EEa"
l
In the presentation of various respiratory volumes, the term BTPS is
ria
often used. This indicates thqt the measurements tuere made at bodg
temperature and ombient pressure, utith the gas saturated tuith uater
,opour. Sometimes to use these values in the reporting of metabolism,
they must be converted to standard temperature and plessure and dry
measurement conditions, indicated by the term STPD'
Most of the air enters the lungs to fill the alveoli after each breath.
A certain amount of air is required to fill the various cavities of the air
passages. This air is called tl:re dead-space air, and the space it occupies
ate
i" fi:,e d-ead space. The amount of air that actually reaches the
"atGa
alveolar interface with the blood stream with each branch is the tidal
volume minus the volume of the dead space.
7 .2.2. Mechanical Measurement
,4"
r"' compliance or performance which has been dehned as the volume
i'/
St
increase in the iungs per unit increase in lung pressllre, requires
measurement of inspired or expired volume of gas and of intrathoracic
#,
?.).
pressure. Normally compliance is a static measurement. However, in
actual practice two types of compliance measurement, static and dynamic
q
yM
are made. Static compliance is determined by obtaining a ratio of the
difference in lung volume at two different volume levels and the associated
d,ifference in intra-alveolar pressure. For measurement of dynamic
compliance, tidal volume is used as the volume measurement, while
intrathoracic pressure measurements are taken during the time when
the airt'low is zero, which occur at the end inspiratory and expiratory
levels with each breath (refer figure 7.3). The performance or lung
compliance varies with the size of the lungs: a child has a smaller
compliance than an adult. Furthermore, the volume-pressure curve 1s
not linear. Therefore, compliance does not remain constant over the
breathing cycle, but tends to d'ecrease as the lungs are inflated'
ud
l
dealing with mechanics of breathing. The complexity of pulmonary
ria
measurements lies not in the variety required but rather in gaining
access to sources of these measurements, and in providing suitable
conditions to make them meaningful in measurement.
All lung volumes and capacities that can be obtained by measuring
the amount of gas inspired or expired under a given set of conditions or
during a specified time interval can be obtained by the use of the
spirometer. The timed vital capacity and forced expiratory volume
measurement can be obtained with the help of spirometer. The only
ate
"'olume
and capacity measurements that cannot be obtained with
spirometer are those requiring measurement of gas that cannot be expelled
'rom the lungs under any conditions. The residual volume, fr.rnctional
:esidual capacity and total lung capacity are included in such
:rreasurements. A recording spirometer is shown tn figure 7.4.
Other Signal
Processing
yM
Kymograph
Strip Charl
ud
Fiecorder
lvlouthpiece
Thermometer for
Spirometer Gas
Temperature
St
of the patient is blocked. Thus as the patient breathes into the tube, the
bell moves up and down with each inspiration and expiration in proportion
to the amount of air breathed in or out. A pen attached to the balancing
weight mechanism and writes on the paper attached to the drum recorder
l
called a kymograph. As the kymograph rotates, the pen traces the
breathing pattern of the patient. Sometimes a rotational displacement
ria
sensor is attached to the drum mechanism. The output of the rotational
displacement sensor is fed to an operational amplifier which can be
connected to an electronic strip chart recorder.
Several bell volumes are availabre but 9 and 13.5 liters are most
common. A well designed spirometer offers little resistance to air flow
and the bell has little inertia. various paper speeds are available for
}<ymographs with 32, 160,30o and 19oo mm/min are most common.
The 9 liter spirometer is most common and can be used in laboratory
ate
or in the physician's chamber.
A waterless spirometers, operate on a principle similar to the
spirometer just described above. one such type is called wedge spirometer.
Some instruments, called electronic spirometers, measures airflow
and by use of electronic circuitry calculates the various volumes and
capacities. Block diagram of such a device can be seen in figure 7.5 (a).
This instrument provides both a graphic output similar to that of a
standard spirometer and a digital read out of the ciesired parameters.
Figure 7.5 lb) shows a typical spirogram. Various types of airflow
yM
transducers are used. A small breath driven turbines and heated wires
that are cooled by the breath are used as transducers.
Signal ,.nd
conditioning
--lm
lrol
::OI
,:e
: flfl
ud
Monitor
display
result
with digital
report
St
l
FJ'.J
ria
MVV
ate o
FEV, VC
yM
Medium Fast Slow
:iii--:nt is then asked to blow out all the air he could as quickly as
'us=:ble to produce FEV, (forced expiratory volume after 1 sec.). To
;r: '-rlate FEV1, a 1 second interval was measured from the beginning
'm --: by extending the maximum slope. Sometime, it is necessary to
==nine the beginning point by extending the maximum slope to the
level of maximum inspiration. This step ensures that the initial friction
and inertia of the spirometer have been overcome and compensates for p
error on the part of the patient in performing the test as instructed. V
Generally respirometry tests are repeated two or three times, and the w
l
maximum values are used to ensure that the patient performed the test h
to the best of his ability. Although some instruments are calibrated for rn
ria
direct read out, other require that the height of the tracings be converted al
to llters by use of a calibration factor for the instrument, called the in
spirometer factor. is
he
Output including digital readouts are available particularly from
lu
electronic types of spirometers. Some instruments even have built in
ch
computational capabilities to calculate automatically the required volumes
vol
and capacities from the basic measurements.
at
ate
7.2.3.1. Measurement of Residual Volume
7.2
The outputs spirometer and of some of the other instruments described
above, all the lung volumes and capacities can be determined except those
me,
that require measurement of air still remaining in the lungs and airways
anc
,) at maximum expiration. These parameters, which include the residual Cire
rt volume, FRC and total lung volume can be measured through the use of
-he
l foreign gas mixture. A gas analyzer is required for these tests.
trei
i
Rebreathing from a spirometer charged with a known volume and :orn
,' concentration of marker gas, such as hydrogen or helium. Helium is "olu
yM
usually used, involves a closed circuit technique. After several minutes .: tl
{ of breathing, complete mixing of the spirometer and pulmonary gases is .r tl
assumed and the residual volume is calculated by a simple proportion : atit
of concentrations and gas volumes. atir
-
Nitrogen washout the open circuit method involves the inspiration of :ata
pure oxygen and expiration into an oxygen purged-spirometer. If the ,fd
patient has been breathing air, the gas remaining in his lungs is
78 percent nitrogen. As he begins to breath the pure oxygen, it will mix
with the gas still in his lungs and a certain amount of nitrogen will T1
\rash out' with each breath. By measuring the amount of nitrogen in ,1:ch
each expired breath, a wash out curve is obtained from which the volume ::tlV(
of air initially in the lungs can readily be calculated. The end expiratorl-
ud
=:bO
level is the preferred breathing ievel for beginning this measurement. .- rap
Tlre functional residual capacity (FRC) (from which residual volume l- : IfL
can also be calculated by subtracting the expiratory reserve volume) can :1Ce.
be measured by using a plethymograph. This instrument is an airtight r .-eIC
box in which the patient is seated. Utilizing Boyle's law the ratio of . .::atr
change in lung volume to change in mouth pressure is used to determine
- 3,1.
the thoracic gas volume.
St
The patient breathes air within the box through a tube which contains inl
a transducer and shutter to close off the tube for certain portion of the "' '. ap
test. Pressure transducer measure the air pressure in the breathing tube i,,.Sta
on the patients side of the shutter and inside of box. The amount of air
in the box, including that in the patient lungs, remaining constant. rH ::1pt
since there is no way for air to enter or escape. However, when the oI
Page No. 129 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Measurements ir: The Respiration System 131
:atlent compresse"
.,
tlume is reduced, totalbody
''''hen the patient "ConverselY
in racic region
-.:s body volume
in The FRC is
rLe?Sllrd with the breathing tube closed. With no air
l
,-lowed to flow the mouth pressure
(sensed by the pressure
---- the tube) can be assumed to
ria
equal the alvetla, p;;";;."
. instructed to breathe at the siow rate against
the closed
expands and compresses the air in his
s in mouth pressure and corresponding
e it is possible to calculate the intrathoraciJ
me is equal to FRC' If the test is performed
the end expiratory level.
' 2.3-2. lntraarveorar and rntrathoracic pressure
ate
Measurement
It used to measure intraalveorar and intrathoracic
. .:a pressures. These
mportant in the determination of toth compliance
] ce, since inaccessibility of tfr""e .hl_bers
makes
mpossible. For measureme
.hutter in the breathing tube is opened to pressure
,:he air from within th! closed Uix. Since
-' a cl0sed system containing :i5:Y
a lixed amount of gas, pressure and
=e variations in the box are the inverse of the pi""".r." variations
lungs as the gas within the rungs expands
-:= positive and negative pressur." andis compressed due
yM
':--:s breathing tube is brocked
i., th" lungs. por cariu.ation the
for a few seconds, during which the
:.: is asked to breathe while mouth pressur" i"
:an be used in calibration of measurement. _.r".rred. These
Since mouth pressure
_ ,lng pressure are the same when
there is no airflow.
l
7.3.2. Respirators and Ventilators
e
Respirators and ventilators are used interchangeably to describe
ria
tt
equipment that may be employed- continuously intermittently to improve
,r"rrtit.tion of the lungs and to suppty humidity or aerosol medications 1S
to the pulmonary tree. Most of the ventilators.in the clinical settings use br
positivL pressure during inhalation to inflate the lungs with various CI
gu.""" or mixture of gases (air, oxygen, carbon dioxide' helium etc')' re
IJnder certain conditions pressure may be applied during the expiratory VC
phase, but expiration is usually passlve' l-lI
Generally respirators in com on use are classified as assistor-
ate
re
controllers, and can be operated in any of three different modes. These of
modes differ in the method by which inspiration is initiated. ve_
Inspiration is triggered by the patient in the assist mode. A pressure
sensor responds to the slight negative pressure that occurs each time de.
the patient attempts to inhale and triggers the apparatus to begin inflating
the lungs. Thus the respirator helps the patient to inspire when he
wants to breathe. A sensitivity adjustment is provided to select the
amottnt of patient effort required to trigger the machine. The patients
who are able to control their breathing but are unable to inhale a
yM
sufficient amount of air without assistance or for whom breathing require
too much effort the assist mode is used'
A timer set to provide the desired respiration rate is controlled in the
control mode breathing. controlled ventilation is required for patients
who are unable to breathe on their own. In this mode the respirator has
complete control over the patients respiration and does not respond to
P(
\eur
any respiratory effort on the part of the patient'
The apparatus is normally triggered by the patient's attempt to breathe
in the assist control mode as in the assist mode. However, if the patient
fails to breathe within a predetermined time, a timer automatica]ly triggers
the device to inflate the lungs. Thus, the patient controls his own breathing
as long as he can, but if he should fail to do so, the machine is able tc
ud
take over for him. This mode is most frequently usel.-t in critical care
settings use this mode quite frequently' '.3.3
Many respirators can be triggered manually by means of a control or- T
the panel in addition to above. : lrll
once inspiration has been triggered inflation of the lungs continues - -ralr
unless one of the following condition occurs: '-^.: a.
orupperairways'Aventilatorthatoperatesprimarilyinthismanne: If
is said to be Pressure-cYcled. i sp
of gas has been delivered to the patien: :
' A predetermined volume
(ii) -lse
This is the primary mode of operation of volume cycled ventilators -, tci
(iirJ The air or oxygen has been applied for a predetermined period
f
time. Thus the mode of operation for time c1'cled ventilators' :- cle
Page No. 131 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
erectricaly powered compressor or carr be used;il"5:B#f,"
ffiE'i3X
ria
to permit ventilation with ambient air.
The volume-cycled ventilator is the second category of
respirator. It
is called a volume respirator. This type of device ,_,"""
Lith". a piston or
bellows to dispense a precisely contio[ea volume for
each breath. In the
critical care setting where patients have purmonary abnormalities
and
require predictable volumes and concentrations of g.",
ate
:esp perated and provide a much greater d_egree
rf control over the ventilation than the pr.""r-r.. cycled types. An ICU
.'entilator is shown in figure 7-6.
Adjustable pressure limit and alarms for safety are available
:evices of this type.
in most
Pneumalic
yM
Control
signals
Trained
network
weights
Training
data and
control
l
volume of minute particles is produced. Such equipment usually consists
of two parts, a generator that produces a radio frequency current to
ria
drive the ultrasonic transd.ucer and the nebulizer itself, in which the
transducer generates the ultrasound enerSr and applies it to the water
or medicatlon. ffre ultrasonic unit d.oes not depend on the breathing gas
for operation. The therapeutic agent can be administered during oxygen
therapy or mechanical ventilation procedure'
To remove mucus and. other fluids from the airways aspirator and
other types of suction apparatus are used'
ate
7.4. SUMMARY
measurement are taken ones the middle half of the forced r','-a']t
capacity from 25oh to the 75o/o level'
Another i nt is maximal expiration flow rate (N{E-tr-
Other im t is maximum breathing capacity (NI
or maximal voluntary ventilation (MW) This is a measul:e of:
maximum amount of air that can be breathed in and blown o\-e:
Page No. 133 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
The standard spirometer consists of a
movabre berl inverted over a
chamber of water inside the bel,, above
ria
the water line, is the gas that
is to be breathed. A pen is attatched to the
balancing arrangement
is called a Kymograph. Sometimes a rotational
dispracement sensor
is attatched to the drum mechanism for the
output to be connected
to the pen recorders.
The other instruments are water ress spirometer
sprrometer.
known as wedge
To produce a spirogram the patient is
aksed to breath through the
ate
mouthpiece. The recorder is first set to
a slow speed of 32 mmr/min
to measure th
patient is
line. He was th
aked ,'Jo'L?,^ ff:.i;::,::i: r[rl.":;rJ::
xhale completely and to inhale as much
as he could' This process produces
thl vital
""p..rty ."cord on the
t rb"r"..iJTjl1l"T"";*ffi],,1:
speed of l92O mm/min.
r W) record the chart speed is set
yM
t r a short rest a few cycles of resting
:espiration were recorded then the patient
rut for 10 seconds producing MV record.is asked to breath in and
i(ow-a-days electronic sparometer are
arso available. For calcurating
- lnctional residual capacity
can be measured from a plethysmograph.
Respiratory Therapy Equipment: If a patient
':ntilation is incapabre of edequate
by natural process, mechanical
::ovided' so that sufficient oxygen is deliveredassistance must be
.ssues of the body.
to the organs and
' ie instruments for respiratory therapy
are inhalaters, ventilators,
tmidifiers and neubulizers.
ud
l
suspended in the inspired air as an aerosol, a device called nebulizer
is used. In a nebulizer t]rle water or rnedication is picked up by a
ria
high-velocity jet of oxygen (or some other gas) and thrown against 7.
ate
Aspirators are used to remove muscus and other fluids from the
airways.
6xerri,ted
l,t'
r/ 7.1. How many loves are there in lungs? Define the important lung capacities
I and explain them. (UPTU-MQPl)
i 7.2. Boyle's law is an imPortant 1aw of physics. How does it relate to breathing
i (UPTU-MQP1)
process.
yM
For what measurement spirometer can be used? what basic lung volumes
D\
7.3.
rt and capacities cannot be measured with spirometer? Why?
(UPTU-MQP1)
7.4. Write in detail about the instrumentation used for measuring the
mechanics of breathing. (UPTU-MQP2)
7.5. Explain d.ifferent respiratory therapy equipment normally used.
(UPTU-MQP3)
7.6. Explain the operation of a pulmonary measurement indicator?
(UPTU-MQP3)
7.7 . Using the correct anatomical and physical terms, explain the process of
respiration, tracing the taking of a breath of an air through the mouth.
ud
(UPTU-MQP3)
7 Explain the physioloSr of a respiratory system. Discuss various parameters
.8.
which are a function of individual's physical characteristics and condition
of breathing mechanism. (UPTU-2003t
7.g. what are plethysmographs? How can they be used for measurement of
intrathoracic pressures? Expiain the methods of airway resistance
measurement
7.10. Discuss various respiratory therapy equipments. what are Nebulizers?
(UPTU-2003,
St
l
of a breath of air through the mouth for
blood in the muscle of an
ria
_.16. athlete's leg.
een death by carbon monoxicle poisoning and
death by strangulation? Explain.
17' Explain the operation of a purmonary
measurement indicator.
18' what causes the rungs to expand
and contract in breathing inspite of the
lungs containing no musculature.
AJJ
ate
yM
ud
St
CO
bc
It
NC
l
ob
ria
Diagonstic Techniques
t'
I
I
t
lr',:
:r fnside this
8.1.
8.2.
8.3.
8.4.
chapter
Ultrasonic Diagnosis
ate
Principles of Ultrasonic Measurement
llltrasonic Imaging
malfunction of the system of the body. Such instrumentation may also : et'
be called troubleshooting equipment. The diagnostic equipments and .he
their underlying principles related with ultrasonic, X-ray, Radio-isotopic, -ah
cAT scan, Emission computerized Tomography and MRI techniques are
ud
l
--beys laws of reflection and refraction as shown in figure 8.1.
ria
Reflected wave
Medition 2 --'
lntedace
ate
Medition 1 Transmitted wave
l
mea
capacity of the materials. frorr
ria
Table 8.1. (b) Ultrasound Absorption
ate
An important characteristic of ultrasound frequency used in biomedical AVOlC
instrumentation is the Doppler effect. If the frequency of the reflected
h
ultrasonic eners/ is increased or decreased by a moving interface, the
frequency shift is given as:
fopr
tne (
,,, Lf=?
')t
t4 A-
for = reflected- wave frequency shift T
t / :r-ans
I u = interface velocity
::ace
)" = transmitted ultrasound wavelength
i
t: :eflec
yM
In other words, the frequency increases if the interface moves towards
{ the transducer and decreases when moves away. If ultrasound is reflected
from a moving object, the measured frequency shift is proportional to
velocity.
The ultrasound is transmitted in various forms. The modes of
transmission are:
(i) Pulsed Ultrasound
It is transmitted in pulsed form at a frequency from I to 12 kHz
Pulse duration is about 1 p sec. The returning echoes are displayed with
respect to time and echoes are proportional to the distance from the
source to the interface. It is used in most of the irnaging applications
ud
F
(ii) Continuous Doppler (b)
Continuous ultrasound signal is transmitted and a separate receivinE
transducer picks up the returning echoes. The frequency shifts rif) M-
due to moving interfaces are detected and the average velocity of the Tre
targets is determined as a function of time. It is used in blood flos- :,'lses
---,: ver
measurements.
s set
St
Diagonstic Techniques'141
l
::easured as a function of time and also as a function of the distance
:.:m the vessel wall.
ria
ULTRASONIC IMAGING
ate
Imaging systems are comprised of the pulsed urtrasound or pulsed
l ppler mode. The received information is amplified and displayed in
: of several display modes:
A-scan display
Transmitted pulses trigger the sweep of an oscilroscope. The D
-:rsmitted pulses and echoes are displayed as vertical defections on the 4.
a
.--e. The figure 8.2(a) shows typical A-scan. Ehoes cause vertical
:lection of oscilloscope.
yM
Transmitted
pulse
(b)
ud
: es. The figure 8.3 shows M-scan of moving and stationary target
--corresponding A-scan. A stationary target trace is a straight line
- respect to time.
B-scan display
is a two-dimensional image of a stationary organ or body structure.
:rightness of the oscilloscope is controlled by ieturning Lchoes. The
Page No. 140 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
B-scan tralsducer is moved with respect to the body and vertieal deflection
of the oscilloscope correspond to the movement of transducer.
Echo from
l
moving target
ria
Transmitted Echo from
pulse stationary
target
ate
M-scan
Corresponding A-scan
Fig. 8.3. M-scan of moving and stationary target with corresponding A-scan
yM
/ ULTRASONIC DIAGNOSIS
4.3.1
u
The ultrasonic diagnosis techniques are used in cardioiogr, abdominal
imaging, brain studies, eye analysis, obstetrics and gznaecologr. The
record may be named using echo or sono words such as echocardiogram
is record of ultrasonic measurement of heart. The echoencephalogram is
a record of ultrasonic measurement of the brain. For eye analysis it is
ultrasonogram. The ultrasonograph is used for imaging of the organ
from several positions and help in visualisation of all four chambers and
all four values of the heart, and also the great arteries and the great
verns.
systems for ultrasonic applications are inclusive of a generator for
ud
available to suit various frequencies upto say 5 MHz and in various sizes
to suit applications. Microprobe needle transducers are also available. TI
- -Jf
Figure 8.4 shows block diagram M-made scanner block diagram. ----er
.:lu
: ::91
l
time^sweP of
ria
start pulse tor
ate
Fig. 8.4. M-mode scanner block diagram
yM
X : '1. Echocardiography
-tr *'
ud
..'.'*
l'
St
value is given as the displacement of the echo per unit time. The
transducer is placed such that the beam crossed the chest wall into the st
right ventricle, through the septum, into the left ventricle and then tl
through the left atrium. The image of aorta and mitral valve are also TT
obtained in this technique.
l
pr
Echocardiography can be used to detect fluids presence surrounding
ria
the heart due to pericardium inflamation and escape of fluid. It may be
noted that transducer selection is depend.ent on the type of investigation
to be performed, physical size of the patient, the anatomic area involved,
the type of tissue to be encountered and the depth of the organs
to be studied.
8.3.2. Echoencephalography
Echoencephalography is ultrasonic imaging using A-scan mode of
ate
display for determination of the location of the midline of the brain. The
transducer is held against the side of the head to measure the distance
to the midline of the brain. The midline echoes from both sides of the
head are displayed on the oscilloscope simultaneously. one side gives
upward deflection of the beam and the other side gives downward (a)
deflection.
If these two deflections line up, then, distance from the midline to
each side of the head is equal. If it is nonaligned, possibility of tumor
or disorder exists. Ultrasound eners/ is upto 1o MHz and pulse rate is
per
yM
1O0O sec.
t 8.3.3. Opthalmic Scans
opthalmic scans are used for the eye. An ultrasound machine block
diagram shown in figure 8.6.
ud
TGC
(b)
Spectral
doppler
processrng
(D mode)
St
l
ria
ate
B-mode ultrasound before treatment of a 75 year old female patient with scleritis
and myositis in both eyes. The patient's left eye has been made visible on
ultrasound The sclera is thickened with 3.0.1 mmm D = distance
yM
ud
*
r" .,j!,a
"-. .-,i
l
also used for therapeutic purposes. This is the domain of the medical
speciality known as radiologz. X-ray equiprnents are major part of medical t
ria
instrumentation. in
m
8.4.1. Basic Definitions fo
X-rays are electromagnetic waves which have a much shorter
wavelength than radio waves or visible light. The X-ray wavelength can CO
ate
8.4.2. Generation of lonizing Radiation r 11.
The X-ray machines are based on principles shown in the Iigure g.9.
T1
' :l-le
St
HV supply :.. I
: --1O(
X-ray
rmagtng
l4 4.
device X-rays tube
l
certain
netal salts), photographic emulsions (X-ray effects of some films) and
;
ria
-mage intensifiers (fluoroscooic image is made brighter). TV camera,
=ronitors, tape-recorders and mobile x-ray machineJ are also available
:or diagnostic purposes.
Special techn grids (scattered X-rays are absorbed),
:ontrast media (fr es of brain with air), angiography (blood
.'essels filled with ials by injection), cardiac catheterization
:atheter insertion through an artery or vein to diagnose valve defects of
::re heart) and three-dimensional visualization are available in X_ray
ate
:-achines. The X-ray naturally, then is also able to diagnose other than
:'lnes or metallic parts. A typical block diagram of X-ray machine is
:.rown in figure 8.10.
yM
o
o
=
a
Mains c
supply kV indication .9
o
C
o
-c
.9)
I
ud
l
to
plastic base. The X-ray film is sandwitched between two screens and di
ria
i<ept in a light tight cassette. Therefore, the film is exposed to X-rays as
*"jl r" to the ight from the fluorescence of the screen. These are SO
intensifying screens. wi
The most commonly used material is calcium tungstate which emits TT
a broad spectrum of light of low intensity in blue wavelength. Before by
coming to the actual exposure, the hlm materials must have been kept
in the darkroom during the past 12 hours, this is considered best pr(
preparation. The adaptation to a new temperature is quite fast and
ate
t1n
t""Lr." within few minutes. It can take several hours for a f,rlm to get ter
dimensionally stabilized after a change in relative humidity.
The storage of the hermetically scaled film packages is usually done 8.4
in a refrigeru.tor. This maintains the f,rlm characteristics even beyond the
expiry date which usually applies for storage under room conditions at lis
ZO"C-. If the package is opened, it can be put back into the refrigerator :ntt
after sealing again. he
The developer is as per recommendation of the film manufacturer. All
)u the parameters during lilm development is kept constant so that a negative
with the same exposure will produce the same quality of negative at
yM
ft anytime. A bath thermometer is used to check the temperature of the
developer. Temperautre of 20 + 2'C for ordinary developer gives best
resulti if kept constant. At room temperature between 18 and 24"C, the
working solution will maintain its properties in an open tray for just
4 hours. The stack solution, kept in a stoppered bottle will preserve
the properties f<rr 2 months if the bottte is half full and upto 6 months
with a rul uottte. These shelf life figures can be improved by keeping the
solutions in the refrigerator and are reduced at higher temperatures.
A developing tray large enough to enable film handling with ease is
selected sufficient dlveloper is put in the tray such that the Iilm can be
completely covered with it. A11 the handling the film is one by touching
ud
only the comes with suitable forceps. No forceps is changed from one
tray to another.
Slide the exposed hlm sheet with emulsion down through the solutior'
and turn it quickly and place it into the solution and start immediatell'
to lift the tray roiationally an each side by about 2 crn. This shoulc
occur in a rhythm of about 5 sec for one full cycle and should continue
for whole developing period. The best development of hlm is done at 20'C
whereas, initially r""t*-.rrded time is to be followed and it is modifi'ec
St
l
ria
After washing, a dip in a wetting
-:ocess. Drying should take place slo
.-::re is about one hour at a relative
ate
-::rrperature.
Scientillation
detector
Crystal Window Threshold
photomultipler
ud
St
o
Start
oo
l
onlY Pulses from the radioisotoPe
ria
used can Pass.
InaradioisotopeScanner,thedet-ectorsarealsoavailable,whichis
slowly moved over the area which is to be examined
for images'
atr
RadiationtherapyisanotherareaofX-rayapplication'Theionizing
CO
effectofX_rayisutllizedintreatmentofdeep_seatedtumor.Insuch
cases very haid X_rays are generated for case of
tumors. Soft X-rays are AC
ate
8.4.6. Digital Radiographic Diagnostic and Therapeutic cr(
This facilitates
Radiography has a digital image stored in a computer'
m(
siE
syt
un
t!
tl 8.4
I
niPulations.
i
Digital X-ray imaging systems comprise of two parts as follows: al
(r) iransducer for X-ray imaging or data collection' lim
yM
(ii) Data slorage, processing and display' :ad
tr The lransducer for X-ray imaging are of two types: :he
(r) Image intensifier TV sYstem' lse
(ii) Radiographic, i.e-, fikn' replacement systems' :ne
a lev
he :nei
::
t of soft tissue' Iodine compound is
a catherer of diamete;
used as contrast material which is injected through
vessels can be
1 to 3 mm. Radi,ogi"prric images or tn" contrast-filled video'
ud
Position
contrast
Fig. 5.12. (a) X-ray transmlsslon cross-section with
Page No. 149 of 328. enhanced vessel images superimposed
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
DiagonsticTechniques 151
(6
c
.?
a
l
ria
Position
Fig. 8.12. (b) Subtracted profile with uniform background to vessel image
Digital subtraction angiography (DSA) is the most important
application. A preinjection image (mask) is acquired. The injection of
:ontrast agent is performed and then images of the opacified vessels are
acquired and subtracted from pre-injection image (mask). This helps in
:ontrast enhancement which increases contrast sensitivity.
- igure 8.72(a\ represents the transmitted X-ray intensity through the
ate
:ross-section of a patient. The small contrast changes due to vessels are
:reshed by a large anotomical background contrast image. It these small
.ignals are attempted to be amplified, it gives to saturation of the display
:r-stem by the large background signals. The subtracted profrle with
,-niform background to vessel image is shown in figure 8.12(b\
3 4.7. Fundamental of Radiation Therapy
4.
Large number of cancer patients receive radiation therapy either as
. primary or adjunctive treatment. The easily X-ray devices were of
.nited use in treating many types of carrcer as the penetration of the ::-,
yM
-:diation was inadequate to treat deep sealed tumours without damaging
.e healthy normal tissues overslying the tumours. These X-ray machines
- sed to be voltages in the range of 400 kV and correspond to a single
-::erg/ of about 133 KeV. Subsequently direct acceleration methods were
-:r'eloped to achieve energies I or 2 million electron volts (MeV). However,
-.ese were cumbersome devices to use, therefore, failed to be used.
ud
St
l
devices. S
Cobalt machine was developed which was simple, compact and reliable o
ria
low-energr radiation treatment device using a pellet of radioactive cobalt p
isotope as a source of radiation. This machine survived for 30 years and sl
they had the tremendous advantage of producing a completely predictable, vl
steady, reliable beam of relative high-energr radiation. It was easy to b
repair and maintain. pr
Today, most of the radiotherapy treatments are carried out using d
conventional radiotherapy linear accelerations. Linear accelerator portion II
accelerates electrons to the required level of ener$/. In short, complete
ate
b.
machine is referred as accelerator. It is designed to deliver a mega- rn
voltage X-ray beam suitable for modern radiotherapy techniques. It is S1
comprised of gantry and stand, treatment couch; and control console. It rll
produces ener5/ ranging from 4 to 20 MeV. The block diagram of
accelerator is shown in figure 8.12(c\
/,_.,
The range of technologies used in the linear accelerator system is
t/
il very wide. It requires high power electronics in the order of megawatts.
I The dose monitoring system has to measure currents of the order of
,t
IA-72 amps. Microprocessor technologr is used. Safety interlocks, gantry
yM
?,:
and patient, support call high technologr and precision.
s
Computerized Axial Tomography (CAT) or computed tomorgraphy (CT)
scanning combines X-ray imaging with computer techniques. CAT permits
visualization of internal organs with greater clarity. The X-ray photograph
is a shadow of all organs and structures in the path of the rays. Whenever
two radiopaque objects lie; one behind the other, in the X-ray path.
the smaller of the two may be completely hidden by the larger, see
figure 8.12(d).
:x
ud
';,-i
a-a
-;,_1
:S
\t*o=: -:
St
Fig. 8.12. (d) X-ray imaging of two objects, one behind the other
l
shadows of the objects at all other distances from the source will move
rn the film and produce a blur. See figure 8.13, the sphere lies in the
ria
:lane that appears stationary, but cube does not. The shadow of the
sphere is hence reinforced as the X-ray vintage point is changed. The
,'intage points for axial tomography are taken around the axis of the
:ody. A very narrow pencil-like X-ray beam scans a single slice
:erpendicular to the body's axis. By scanning two or more slices, a three
rimentional representation can be created. The measurement is done by
:reans of one or more sodium, iodine or calcium chloride crystal detectors
:i- scintillating in proportion to the intensity. The scintillation light is
ate
:--easured by photomultiplier tubes. X-ray source and film move
..multaneously in opposite direction. One plane appears stationary on
---m and small sphere lies on.the same plane.
4.
--
yM
Fig. 8.13. Linear tomography X-ray source and film move simultaneously in
opposite direction. One plane appears stationary on film and small sphere
bias on the same plane
Present day CAT scanners use X-ray sources which provide fan beams
-: multiple detectors to simultaneously measure the density across a
ud
, :r position of the slice. The figure 8.14 shows the fastest instruments
':.:ng a fan beam that covers the complete width of the slice. Several
' -:-dred detectors are used to measure the density pattern of the slice
; --- good resolution. The time for co:mplete scanning of a slice is as low
i'/, secs. High scanning rates are feasible which permit scanning
-,-1 sections of the body and the p,atient is made to hold the breath
-
- ,ie completely still for few seconds in order to complete the scanning.
- :hronizing scans with the ECG helps to reconstruct slices of the
St
l
ria
Gr
ate
X-ray source
]I
:.S
.r_-(
.:
ud
47.
is pla
throu
detector. The source of made moving or detector or both across
the sectior'
of the body. The measurements are rnade at regular intervals. An electron
beam CT scanner is shown in frgure 8'16'
l
Crystal
ria
Focus coil
Deflect on
corl
3un
ate
Fig. 8.16. An electron-beam CT scanner
yM
!6 EMISSION COMPUTERIZED TOMOGRAPHY
;-.lioactive isotopes of certain elements can be used to trace the
-.:abolism, pathways, and concentrations of the body parts. Emission
=puterized tomography can provide detailed three-dimensional
: .:ribution map of an isotope which is injected into the body and
r .',\-ed to distribute itself. The three-dimensional image is created by
r::--fl9 scans of several slices. Naturally instrumentation for emission
::-puterized tomography is very sophisticated. such methods are being
l' tloped for ultrasonic imaging of the heart and abdominal organs.
ud
l: MRt
l{t.i:etic Resonance Imaging (MRI) is based on the nuclear properties of
T- :-rgen atoms in the body. Elements having odd number of protons
'l:'' ,-'-rcleus have magnetic properties. Such elements are hydrogen in
-1,
:n -13, oxygen -17, sodium -23, Fluorine -19, phosphorus _3 1, etc.
, gen atom nucleus has a single proton which being odd number
::re property of spin as given in figure 8.17. This works like magnet
--. the patient is placed in a strong magnetic field, the magnetic
St
'l: -:nts of protons align with or against the field lines of the magnet
-r,$rn in figure 8.18.
I I t
l
I t t
ria
3
I I t t
I 1I
Main magnetic field a
ate
p
Fig. 8.17. Spinning of hydrogen protons Fig. 8.18. Alignment of hYdrogen
spinning off its vertical axix protons
-top
A small excess of magnetic moments of protons align with the field 8
RE.
T)Ureceiver
St
l
the extent of the dissection within aorta.
(iif cine gradient echo for assessing cardiac contractile function.
ria
(iu) cine MRI gives tomograms of heart beats in a cinematic format.
(u) Velocity encoded cine-MRI to estimate heart beat gradient across
valvular stenosis and blow flows in heart.
MRI is a noninvasive technique with excellent soft tissue contrast.
l,lRI is a slow process, relatively expensive. It can not image bones. MRI
s used for soft tissues-brain, vessels of brain, eyes, inner ear, heart,
,rdominal vessels, kidney, etc. Naturally it is able to diagnose related
ate
::oblems of the organs.
SUMMARY
Non-invasive diagnostic: It does not involve getting inside the body
physically or invading it while conducting the diagnostic. These are
not traumatic for the patient and do not have any determinant side ,
4.
effects on the patient.
asonic measurements: When sonic energr at
KHz (i.e. above audible range), the reflected energr
yM
e difference of densities between the two media
and the angle at which transmitted beam hits the medium. Higher
the difference in media, the higher will be the reflexion.
Doppler effect is an important characteristic of ultrasound frequeuncy.
The modes of ultrasound transmission are pulsed ultrasound used
lor imaging applications, continuous doppler used for blood flow
neasurement, Pulsed Doppler for measurement of velocity and
distance of moving object and range-gated pulsed doppler used for
clood flow rate.
ultrasonic Imaging: Ultrasound imaging systems are comprised of
he pulsed ultrasound or pulsed doppler mode. The information
ud
l
techniques. The CAT scanners can provide information about internal
organs and body structure which corrld not be done by conventional
ria
X-ray photographs.
7. Emission Computerised Tomography: Radioactive isotopes of certain
elements can be used to trace the metabolism, pathways and
concentrations of the body part. It can create 3-dimerrsional image
for diagnostic purposes.
8 MRI: Magnetic Resonance Imagaing (MRI) is based on nuclear
properties of hydrogen atoms in the body. The MRI images are accurate
ate
for tumors, inflammatory and vascular abnormalities.
6xercidea
8.1. What do you understand by the term "noninvasive methods"?
8.2, What is meant by uitrasonic imaging? Compare ultrasonic diagnosis with
X-ray diagnosis. (UPTU-MQPI)
8.3. What do you mean by diagnosis? Expiain X-ray diagnosis technique.
What is the difference between X-ray and radioisotope methods for
diagnosis? (UPTU-MQPI)
yM
8.4. Explain the principle of CAT scan and compare its visualisation method
H with conventional method. (UPTU-MQPL)
8.5. Discuss the principle and use of the ultrasonic measurements in medical
diagnosis. (UPTU-MQP21
8.6. Write a shot note on the instrumentation for the medical use of
radioisotopes. (UPTU-MQP2)
8.7. Discuss the properties of ultrasound and how ultrasound can be used for
diagnosis. (UPTU-MQP21 .'\'h
8.8. Explain the principle of computerised axial tomography and compare its
:-e
methods of visualisation with conventional X-ray methods. (UPTU-MQP3.r
flo
8.9. What is echocardiography? (UPTU-MQP3I
8.10. Explain the working principle of CT scan with block diagram. (
ud
(UPTU-200s (r
8.11. What are the properties of ultrasound? Discuss the basic modes oi
transmission of ultrasound? (UPTU-2003 tll
8.12. Discuss various types of ultrasound imaging. Explain its application in ttt
ophthalmic scans and echoencephalography. (UPTU-2003 (r
8.13. Explain and describe emission computerised tomography. (UPTU-2004 tu
8.14. Explain and describe echo-encephalography. (UPTU-2004
8.15. Explain and describe CAT scan. (UPTU-2004
St
3.1.
Jia ::Ot
--:et
-:al
-. c
::t
Page No. 157 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
Biotelemetry
'henever
it is necessary to monitor physiological eve.ts from a distance,
of biotelemetry becomes important. The requirements which need
iotelemetry are:
(rJ Monitoring of astronauts in space by radio-frequency
transrnissions.
ud
izr) Monitoring of patients while exercising since conne cting leads are
cumbersome and dangerous.
iiz) Monitoring of patient in an ambulance.
iLr) Medical data transmission from home or office.
tLr) Research on unanesthetized animals
ilrJ Isolation of an electrically susceptible patient.
St
INTRODUCTION TO BIOTELEMETRY
:telemetry is the measurement of biological parameters over a distance.
.thoscope is the example of biotelemetry of simple nature. In this case
art beats are amplified acoustically and transmitted through a hollor,r,
:e system which is picked up by the ear of the physician for inter-
Page No. 158 of 328. 159
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
i. e., radio transmission.
ria
9.2. PHYSIOLOGICAL PARAMETERS ADAPTABLE TO BIOTELEMETRY
The space programme at NASA facilitated use of telemetry. Electro-
cardiography by surface electrodes, indirect blood pressure by contact
microphone and culf, etc. are examples of telemetry.
However, present technologr allows that aly measurement is adaptable
to telemetry. This can be divided in two categories for medical applications:
ate
(0 ECG, EMG and EEG bioelectrical variables. CA,
(it) Transducers based physiological variables for blood pressure, blood an
.tIow, temperatures, etc. In the first category, the electrical signals lm
are directly available whereas in the second category electrical
t1 signals are outcome of transducers. Most widespread use of
biotelemetry for bioelectric potentials is in the transmission of
electrocardiogram. Biotelemetry experiments have been conducted
almost on all animals.
yM
9.3. THE COMPONENTS OF BIOTELEMETRY SYSTEM
k A simple system of biotelemetry will be considered. The telemetry system
transmitter is illustrated in figure 9.1.
ud
transmission.
The receiver circuit is shown in figure 9.2.It has a tuner for selectio=
of tuner frequency a dernodulator to separate the signal from the carrir
wave. It also has some method of recording or displaying the signat.
Biotelemetry 161
Receiver Antenna
l
ria
Fig. 9.2. Biotelemetry receiver system
Biotelemetry systems use radio transmission. A radio-frequency (RF)
ate
:arrier is a high frequency sinusoidal signal when applied to appropriate
=:rtenna gets propagated in the form of electromagnetic waves. Some
---:rportant terminologz are:
R""nge-{he distance the transmitted signal can be received..
Modulotion-Process impressing information upon the carrier.
Demodulation-Recovery of the signal from RF carrier.
|1
The Figure 9.3 shows various stages of the waves and two basic .{-
:'.'stems of modulation.
yM
Signal
Carier wave
ud
Amplitude modulated
(AM)
Frequency modulated
(FM)
St
l
pulses. One simple pulse modulation is shown in hgure 9.4.
ria
Pulse Pulse
(iii
ate
circuit. The stage amplfication and demodulation is also shown.
Transducer bridge
yM
Fig. 9.5. Blood pressure telemetry transmitter
In the figure subcarrier is low frequency, generally audio range of
frequency.
The signal is picked up by receiver. Composite signals are separated.
reformed and demodulated. The syn-signal separator and amplifiers are
used. Finally simple integration yields the original data.
5.i TI
ud
!MPLANTABLE UNITS
Sometimes it is desirable to implant the telemetry transmitter or receiver
in the subject. Generally implanting of transmitters is done in animals
for experimentation purposes. Stimulation of nerves in the patients is
done through implanted receivers. While planning implantation it is
important to know that surgery is not complicated and there is no risk
involved on the patient. Once the implanting is done, it is not taken ou:
for servicing, hence, it must be reliable and battery should have long life
St
Biotelemetry 163
l
ria
A complete set of imprantable
ate
unit comprises of transducer,
-:i' power source and necessary leads. The implantable transmitter
' : single-channer blood pressure transmitter, temperature
units
urrrLo in use
rrt qJc
transmitter.
" =:e are several implantations on dogs for experiment.,i,r.
prrpo""".
rqlyvevo.
relemetry of ECGs from extended coronary
care for cardiac patients
'ry much in use' In this arrangement, each
:'d securely to his chest' The electrodes patient has ECG electrodes
U UTSU
are connected to a sma,
LI ULTCS
l
Calvarium4
i- Dura mater
ria
Cortex
lnsulation Wire
Evelet Ag sphere
(a) Q)
cluster of Fine (b)
Wires, lnsulated
9.1
ate
))
)3.
electrodes (a) wire loop electrode, (b) silver-sphere cortical-
- 9.6. lmplanatable
Fig.
surface potential electrode, (c) Multielement depth electrode
<4-
:6.
yM
*
SUMMARY
1 Biotelemetry: Biotelemetry is the measurement of biological param
over a d.istance. Stethoscope is the example of biotelemetry of sin
nature where in heart beats are amplihed acoustically and transmr
through a hollow tube system which is placed up by the ear of
physician for interpretation. Present day, biological data are conve
into suitable form to be radiated by an electromagnetic held,
radio transmission, is the high tech example of biotelemetry use
biomedical instrumentation.
Physiological Parameters adaptable to Biotelemetry: ECG'
ud
2.
u.t a BUC bioelectrical variables, also transducer based
phy
variables for blood pressure, blood flow, temperature, etc'
J. Components of Biotelemetry System: It has two maJor F
tranJmitter which comprises of Electrodes Transducer, Amp
Processor, Modulator, Carrier and transmitting antenna, and rece
antenna, tuner, demodulator, tape recorder, chart recorde:
oscilloscoPe.
St
Biotelemetry 165
5. Telemetry for ECG measurements during excerise:
while exercising
on a treadmill, the transmitter unit is Lounted on the belt and
electrodes are fixed on the body.
Telemetry,for
l
6.
toring: Ambulances need to
oe equtpect w to allow ECG and other
ria
physiological
intlrpreta=tion. In addition two way rroi". trrT";r*:ffT
for the benefrt of the patient.
ff?*;ii:
C
O.E erci,1e,J
ate
(UPTU_MQP1)
:2. Explain how four physiorogical parameters can
telemetered simultaneously.
be monitored and
ppfu_Mepl)
Discuss telemetry as an emergency tool. ppTu_Mepl)
what are the components of a bio-telemetry system? what
applications of telemetry in emergency patient monitoring? are the
(upru-MQp2)
Pl""]:: various applications ef bio-telemetr5 Explain the
Bio-LINK PWM transmitting system. working of a
(U1TU_20O3)
9a How can telemetry be done for ECG measurements
from extended coronary care patients?
durii! exercise and
ppTU_20O3)
yM
p1r1"l" the components of a bio-telemetry system with the help of neat
labelled diagram.
Draw a block diagram of a system to send an electroca
,orr*r'.!{{r"'rfo^11
ambulance to a hospital by telemetry.
JJJ
ud
St
cal
cor
l
ria
Therapeutic and
:* fnside this
Prosthetic Devices
cll.,c,Ptcr
10.1. Aucliometers and Hearing Aids
ate
yM
10.2. MYoelectric ARM
10.3. LaParoscope
10.4. Summar5'
The
:\'It!
medicine' Most of r -.stacl
A major use of medical electronics is in diagnostic
carryout some procesl .--e ty-n
instruments sense various physiological signals' -
:it#-;;;;j., ai"pr"vt' "Jo'd them' rhere is a class of med
;"; the
electronic devices that are Lseful therapeutically
or as prostheses' ,-:Toufi
1 1.
----! 1.:le on
examplesareelectricsimulators,incubators'ventilators'heart-lu:
ud
","'
are covered here'
i:,_ n tht
LaparoscoPe -:''- :luid
l'e :he ba
loll] AuDloMETens axo neantxc nlos .,- sensl
:s ln
10.1.1. Mechanism of Hearing ::lC I
St
l
ria
Semicircular
canals
,,
Vestibular
nelve
,//
Tympanic
membrane
ate Eustachian tube
.ft,--
i.l
li
a-
-
yM
Fig. 10.1. Anatomy ()f the human ear
The tympanic membrane separates the ear canal from middle ear
:avity which is exposed to atmospheric pressure only through the
:ustachian tube, which connects it to the pharynx and nose or mouth.
- he tympanic membrane transmits
.l the middle air, to the receptortht: sound ener$/ through the cavity
ct:lls in the inner ear, which are
.urrounded by fluid. All these are coulrled to the oval window, j.e., total
:rrce on the oval window is the same as that on the tympanic membrane.
ud
10.1.2. Audiometer ;
Ior-
The device, used to test the auditory response is known as audiometer.
ou
A basic audiometer is an oscillator driving a pair of earphone and is wit
calibrated in terms of frequency and acoustic power, which cart be adjusted
l
over the audio range. Aud.iometer also provided with a calibrator, noise
ofr
ria
source and bone-conductor-vibrator. It has two channels-first channel
tha
has pure tone or speech output and the second channel has either
.r"..o* band. or wide band marking signal. Independent attenuator and to(
transducers exist for each channel. 10.
Transmission of sound through the external and middle ear to internal
ear is called air conduction. The transmission of sound to the internal
ear via an electromechanical vibrator applied to the mastoid bone is
called bone conduction. Bone vibrator contains a piezoelectric transducer.
ate
Loud speakers d.eliver auditory stimuli which converts electrical signals
to audible vibrators. A permanent record of an audiometer is called
audiograph.
Audiometers are classified as:
(r) Rrre tone audiometer
(ir) Speech audiometer.
10.1.2.1. Pure Tone Audiometer
It generates test tones in octarre steps from 125 Hz to 8 kHz with
signal intensity ranging from 10 dI3 to l2O dB. Hearing loss, associated
yM
$
*itt -iadte ear disease, can be evsluated with pure tone more accratel]-
than speech test as the frequency and intensity can be controlled with T]
high degree of precision. Pure tor:e audiometer is composed of an LC M
o"Lillrto. which is controlled to an output current amplifier stage to A(
produce the necessary power lerrels. Ladder attenuators are used ic LI
these instruments of nominal impedance of 1O ohms. The output signa'
is coupled to a small loudspeaker or an earphone which helps in hearing MJ
by aii conduction and a tone vibrator for hearing by bone conduction RI
10.1.2.2. Speech Audiometer AN
Speech audiometer is used in the differential diagnosis of hearing Th
disorder and in the assessment of social handicap. Pre-recorded speecb - lifl
ud
is used, as a test signal. A doubl'a band tape recorder is used to interfacl -::st
the two channel audiometer units. Two head phone of L.S. of 25 warrs, lE:em
for each channel are available. r::ed
:+ -.i'or
&l -st(
lhe
St
: :-eC1
'stl
30 to 5o percent sensory cells in the inner ear may have gone l--- r
l
The invention of semiconductor electronics have enabled development
of small and efficient integrated circuits which can be packed in a form
ria
that frts behind or in the ear. The primary function of a hearing aid is
:o compensate for the 10ss of sensitivity of the impaired ear.
10.1.3. 1. Conventional Hearing Aid
A basic hearing aid is shown in frgure 10.2.
ate
yM
Fig. 10.2. Conventional hearing aid and block diagram
The functional parts are:
MlC-microphone and associated preamplifier.
-\GC-automatic gain control circuit.
LPF and HPF-a set of active filter.s, i.e. low pass filter and high pass
:f.
\{ixer-a mixer and power amplifier.
REC-a transducer or receiver.
.\M / PR-audiometer/ programmer.
The complete circuit works on a battery. The multiple channel helps
:ifferent frequency range which can be adjusted with potentiais.
ud
l
the outer ear. th
ul
ria
10.1.3.2. Digital Hearing Aid th
It gives greater dynamic range with less power consumption and 1n
greater complexity. A digital hearing aid block diagram is as shown in
figure 10.3.
MIC-microphone
ADC-analog to digital converter
DSP-digital signal processor
ate
REC-receiver
AM / PR-audiometer/ programmer
{
\
yM
$
Fig. 10.3. Digital hearing aid and block diagram
The soundwaves are picked up by the microphone which is
transformed into electrical signals. The electrical signals are converteC
into digital form. The digital processing device contains an array to :_tn(
adders, multipliers and resisters to provide the fundamental operations .nd
for implementing various digital algorithms. The digital technologr is
implemented with CMOS technologr. The digital hearing aids provide 10.2
capabilities of ease of fitting and stable superior long term performance 1
-fmi
ud
_ata
1- SO
The difference between inanimate and animate objects is that the animate : lra.
move, i.e., respond to their environment and show changes in their bodl
functions. These properties are called behaviour which are controlled [r : ntle
the nervous system known as neurologz. The body parts are connecteC ,:eri
to the brain through nerve hbers. Nerves that carry sensory information
from the various parts of the body to the brain are called afferent nen-es =:e l
-
- ,lol
St
and the ones that carry signals from the brain to operate various musc '---p
are called efferent nerves. [,::e i
Countless feedback loops control the action of muscles. The muscl ---:cu
them selves contain stretch and position receptors that permit prec:
control over the operation. Many of the routine muscular movements
the body are not controlled by the brain at all but are reflexes of
Page No. 169 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Therapeutic and Prosthetic Devices 171
spinal chord. The spinal chord gives almost automatic response to input
stimuli through nuclei of neurons. In short, the muscles of the hand
create bioelectric potentials which in turn create motor actions of gripping
and rotation of the hand. Myoelectric arms are based on the principle
l
that bioelectric potentials serve as input signals which is taken by the
unit for action and once action is complete, feedback signal is given to
ria
the hand for being fed to nerve f,rber. The myoelectric arm can be divided
in two parts.
(zJ Animation control systems (ACS)
(irJ Prosthesis configuration units (PCU)
6
yM
Fig. 10.4. Animation control system (ACS) components
The ACS components mount inside the prosthesis and control all the
'-.nctions of the patient, controlling the hand and wrist, battery charging
,:-d energz management (see figure 10.4).
'A.2.1. Prosthesis Gonfiguration Unit (PCU)
The PCU devices are basically a window into the prosthesis, they
-irmunicate with ACS via wireless communications limbs to gather
ud
-.^:a from the arm and display it during experimentation. The PCU is
, =o used to diagnose the prosthesis and to "fine-tune" the operating
; .:ameters to match the patient. The PCU allows the medical professional
'see" what is happening inside the prosthesis, in real time, while
; '.rent is wearing the myoelectric arm. All parameters relating to the
.ration of the arm can be monitored and adjusted from the PCU
'.= figure 10.4). A digital wireless communication link allows the PCU
r,rmmunicate with the prosthesis upto about 50 feet away. This allows
St
oF
Realtime Monitor
ac
SER 11
Status : Closing
w(
l
E th,
ria
tl thr
H
po'
als
ma
ate
10.2.2. Animation Control System (ACS) Lar
difi
The ACS monitor and control all the functions related to the operation rnn
of the hand and wrist. These are microcomputer based systems which The
interpret patient commands, determine the best method of operating the are
'/ hand and wrist to match the command, and then drive the hand or wrist :ap
in an energr efficient manner. These are unique methods of interpreting
the patient sensors which allows the system to adapt to virtually any
a_re
prosthesis. The ACS module is round and mechanically designed to snap iit)
into the wrist of a prosthesis designed. A plug-in adapter with gold- 'l
plated connections allows direct contact to the slip-ring contacts on the (0
ud
in)
10.2.3. Rechargeable Lithium Battery
ir)
Animate prosthesis use rechargeable lithium battery. The rechargeable
lithium batteries have proved to be the best choice primarily because
they have two to four times more eners/ for a given size and weight thar-
technologies such as nickel cadmium and nickel metal hydride. These
batteries do not have the "dreaded effect" and can be recharged at an1
St
optimal charge. This allows the battery to perform properly daily and
achieve its overall life.
The ACS should shut off the battery if it detects a problem that
would waste ener5/ or otherwise damage the battery. The circuitry inside
l
the battery provides automatic protection from external problems that
the ACS can not control that would physically damage the cells.
ria
The charging of the battery is simply pluging the connector from the
power source supplied to with the ACS into the charging part which can
a-lso have indicating lights. Small size batteries are available which can
match the size, weight and energr to the prothesis and patient.
ate
Laparoscopic surgery is very intensive technologically and is completely
Cifferent approach to operative intervention. The response to this
-nnovative method of instmmentation has revolutionized the medicare.
The vigrous research, development and challenging problem solving efforts
ere continuing in this field. The technological growth in this area is
:apidly expanding. The discussion of some of the available equipments
-e being taken up here.
Laparoscopy has played a major role in grnological surgcries initially
:overing tubal ectopic pregnancy, but subsequently in wider use in ovarin
:-rmors and laparoscopic hysterectomy.
yM
l,aparoscopic surgery reduces post operative pain. Narcotic analgesics
-e seldom required. Padent recovery is fast and he cal be discharged early
:-ed can go back to work quickly. It is especially superior and wound
::oblems like hematoma, infection, scar h5pertrophy and hernia are
--jnimum. The laparoscopic surgery can be for diagnostic purposes such
l
scope as a ring at the tip of the instrument. The diameter of the telescope an
used these days are 5 or 10 mm instrument.
ria
ele
The telescopes are either forward viewing or oblique. A O-degree
instrument provides an image. Oblique viewing scopes have an angle of l.e,
30 degrees to 45 degrees off the center lines of the instrument. It is used ex(
for areas not accessible such as over the dome of the liver.
A the proximal end of telescope, there is an eyepiece which is used Ge
as an attachment for the camera. arI
-{s
The adapter, which joins the camera and the telescope by means of r
ate
COI
a C-mount, also contains a focusing lens. The telescopes have been
designed with camera as an integral part. Laparoscopic system with
distal lens washing as well as an irrigation channel directed toward the anc
operative site are available. The
:Tte(
Miniature light weight camera weighing 40 gms or lesser are used.
It has CCD chip of size Yz" having 3O0,OOO light sensitive pixels. 10.:
Each pixel responds electrically in proportion to the number of photons
to which it is exposed. .'.itt
Light source is generally either Xenon or metal halide bulb having ',,,-itl
yM
life of approx. 250 hour. The light is provided to the laparoscope througL- .rd
k hberoptic cable. _':lto
-,:e(
10.3.3. lnsufflator and lrrigator
The exposure is achieved by insufflation of the peritoneal cavity wir-
: le(
gas such as carbon dioxide (CO2) .This permits safe introduction an; - r-af
manipulation of cannals to accomodate the laparoscopic telescope an: a- co
laparoscopic instruments. The flow of carbon dioxide creases automatical-.
when a preselected intra-abdominal pressure is achieved. A rearculatir:; ..t
1
pump exchanges and hlters carbon dioxide to remove smoke and debris. --u-
i.1atr
It simultaneously maintains stable intra-abdominal distention pressure
: -:cl
Display of carbon dioxide pressure and flow rates are available.
ud
, _:h
Management technique of bleeding is done by an effrcient high flor
irrigator f aspirator unit. It has the ability to direct a forceful fluid strea:: '0.3.
coupled with rapid aspiration of clots and fluid. It is best accomplished dol'-g
L
two jobs with the same tube by alternating the suction and irrigation fi.mctior-:
.-lL
Operating rooms are as usual equipped with nitrogen as a pressu= ,_rc
source. The nitrogen powered irrigation system is used for laparoscorr:
Ir
irrigation which provides a fluid stream from a 80 psi source and is se- '-- a(
-'t
effective in hydrodissection. Standard irrigation bags are connectrd
St
l- ::I-1
through the disposable diaphragm pump. Some irrigationi units a-= * 1t
structured to accept an electrocautery or laser probe without interpret: r.:11
with the irrigation/suction function. rl-l I
l
and dissection. Many instruments have connectors and are insulated for
electrocantery.
ria
The multipurpose tools are single instrument serving several functions,
i e., retraction, aspiration, irrigation, and electrocantery. Instrument
exchange time is minimized and less access ports are required.
Any type of effector tip can be placed at the end of an instrument.
General purpose grasers and dissectors have relatively short narrow
arms capable of performing with teasing, tearing or streching maneuvers.
.\ssorted reusable graspers and dissectors with various handle
ate
--onfiguration.
Enopath bowel instrument are an Endo Babcock and Allis grasper,
:nd an occlusive bowel clamp, a kelly clamp, and a right angle dissector.
lhese have features of fiongeitip shaft rotation and a jaw locking
rechanism.
10.3.5. Suturing and Ligation lnstruments
Intracorporeal suturing and knot tying instruments are available
;.ith laparostopic system. Absorbable ald non-absorbable suture materials
;.ith short ski and straight needles have been made available. A suture
yM
.rd need.le combination is either free standing or attached to a disposable
,-rot pusher. A single use devices are available which include a curved
-eedle with needle driver and pretied knot.
A pretied suture loop can be applied if a free pedicle requires ligation,
r:ecially useful for structures which are not suitable for clipping for
:\ample, the appendiceal base or larger blood vessles. The ligature is
--corporated into its own plastic holder with a preformed loop'
These devices available for laparoscopic use deliver a large staple
-:-d-on in a fashion similar to a skin stapler. The stable crimps to a box
::tape, providing a firm non-necrosing approximation of the tissues.
: -ich devices are being used for mesentric closure and for hernia repair
ud
i -.:h mesh.
Anesthesia Anesthesiologist
Equipment
A
Video
U
l
or Monitor
ria
FA
ate
lnstrument Table
l
1
I
I
I
t
yM
areas of uses of laparoscopic system. Improvements in such l
instrumentation for the benefit of Bio-medical uses are under continuous I
development for the patient care.
q
OEE
^ 0.1.
coz
lnsufilaor '-0.2.
0.3.
1 Surgeon
Assistant ^
-z
surgeon HF Bipolar - 0.4.
ud
Coagulation
lrrigation - 4.5.
Aspiration
_16.
Scrub Nurse
lnstrument Table
St
l
ear.
ria
l. conventional hearing aid is These are lithium operated, programmable
electronic circuit which is packaged in a miniature housing for fitting
on the ear.
Digital hearing aid: gives greater dynamic range with less power
consumption, but with greater complexity. It is cMos technoloSr
device which fits on the ear'
Myoelect ciple that bioelectric potential
as by the unit for action' Once
ate
serve
action is iven to the hand for being fed
to nerve fiber. It has two parts namely Animation Control System
(ACS) and Prosthesin configuration Units (PCU). It is backed by
rechargeable lithium battery.
yM
pregnancy, overin tumers and laparoscopic hysterectomy, etc'
J-,xerci,le,l
aiJ
St
l
ria
Nervous System
(:''
t'
:e. fnside this chaPter
11.1. Introduction
tL.2. Anatomy of Nervous SYstem
r 1.3. Central Nervous SYstem
ll .4. Brain Organisation
ate
yM
1 1.5. Neural Communication
1 1.6. Neuronal Firing Measurements
i 1.8. Summary
11.1. INTRODUCTION
,r"*or" system is the most complex of all the systems of the body, set
figure 11.1 (o) and 11 (b).
Nervous system has the following attributes:
(r) Consists of brain.
(ir) Numerous sensing devices.
(iii) A high-speed communication network which links all parts of re
body.
St
t78
Page No. 177 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
ganglion
Spinai nerves
gangilon
SYMPATHETIC DIVIS]ON
ate
PARASYMPATHETIC DIVISION
Fig. 11.1. (a). Automatic nervous system, pre, preganglionic neuron; post.
postganglionic neuron, RC, ramus communicates
Clliary ganglion
Midbrain I
'il,
) cl.
lvledulla
I
\ E
yM
Lg
Spina
cord
ud
T)
St
PLAN EXECUTE
l
ria
Fig' 11.1. (c) Control of voluntary movement
ate
yM
li
*
Cell
nucleus Cell body
Axion
hillock
ud
l
ria
Nissl substances
ate
Node of Banvier
Axon (nyllin sheath interuptional of
bush regular intervals) help in speed
of transmission of
Nucleas of schwannal
Neurilemma
(insulatory material surrounding
--4
===) -::::
--:: --
myelin sheath)
:#
_--
---1
I
-J-_
Hu= is
--I:l
yM
Fig. 11.3. Spiral motor neuron
ud
St
l
more dendrites input fibres and the axort i.e., a long transmitting fibre
NIany times the axon branches into two or more terminals near ending= ,i0
ria
of the axon.
Figures I1.2, 11 .3, 11.4, show three different types of neurons. It -= tt)
important to note some of the aspects in the figures.
(r) Axon hillock is the portion of the axon immediately adjacent to ti-:
cell bod5r. At this point action potential are generated many times
(rl) Collaterals are the branches which leave the main axon'
(iii) Some types of neurons have axons or denoted coating of a fa:1
ate
insulting material known as myelin. This coaiing is known as mye-l
sheath and the fiber is considered to be myelinated'
(iu) To hetp the speed of. transmission of information along the nen':
in some cases, the myelin sheath is interrupted at regular inten',
by the nodes of Ranvier.
(rr) Myelin sheath is surrounded by another insulting layer know-r:
neurilemma outside of the central nervous system. Neurilemma
mad.e up of thin cells known as Schwann cells. This layer.
thinner then the myelin sheath and is continuous over the
of Ranvier.
yM
(ui) It is difhcult to identify a dendrite from an axon just by appearr-
The function of fibre and the direction in which it comes
information with respect to ceIl body gives the main differe
between a dendrite and an axon.
luii\ A bundle of individual nerve fibres is known as nenre. Nerve {l:
are basically axons and dendrites. Sensory information from diffe:
parts of the body to the brain are through afferent nerves. Effe:
different nerve signal muscles from the brain for operating'
Myelinated ltbre i.e. axons or dendrites exist in some type:
neurons. Myelination is a coating with fatty insulting subs::
known as myelin. The coating is known as myelin sheath'
ud
l
are known as white matter.
iil) central nervous system has collections of neuronal
ria
cell bodies which
are known as ganglia.
ru) Most of the structures of the central neryous
system are anatomically
duplicated on both sicles 1.e., bilateralry symmetrical. Inspite
of this
many functions of CNS in human beings are located non_
symmetrically. Some of the functions are crossed over for function
relationship of left side and right side of the brain.
-J Peripheral nerves are outside the central neryous system. peripheral
nerves may have even cel bodies contained *ithi^ the centra]
ate
nervous system. Afferent nerves are mixed throughout their length.
The nerves that bring sensory informatio., contror motor
functions are known as afferent peripheral nerves. "ira
Afferent nerves th-at bring sensory information are called sensory
nerves, whereas afferent nerves that control the motor functions
of
muscle are called motor neryes. peripheral nerves reave the ?
sprnar
cord at different levers of spinal cord, the nerves that innervate at
a
given level of the body structure come from a given
revel of spinal 6
cord.
- Interconnections occur at or near cerl
yM
bodies and it is known as
synapses. The mammarian neurons synapse do not touch
each
other. They come in crose proximity foi aciivating the axon
of one
lerve or cell body of another which produces a chemical for
stimulating the membrane of a dendrite or cer body. one axon
rroduced chemical near another axon may be ror inhibrting
the
second axon from activating a neuron with which it communicates
rormally. It can be seen that chemical flow or communication is
-rnidirectional.
ud
St
l
ria
Au cNS Spinal cord
sympathetic NS
ate
Metencephalon Metencephalon MYlencePhalon
ll
Telencephalon Diencephalon
I I
I
+ i i
Cerebral cortex Thalamus Tectum Pons cerebellum Medulla
basal gangilia hypothalamus tegmentum
hippocampus
amygdala
Cerebrum
yM
uioorain{viobrain ffi
Cerebellum
Hindbrain
iSpinal
jcord
ud
Sp na
CocYgea
St
l
ria
ate
Spinal Cord
,.
4
Fig. 1'1.5. (b) The brain and spinal cord I
yM
' s believed that certain functions are indicated for certain parts of the
:-.:n. However, in infant animal by remaining certain parts responsible
: - :ertain functions were removed, the animal is able to develop that
r- :tion to some extent. See figure 71.6(a) which shows cut-way section
ri' :.uman brain and hgure 11.6 (b) which shows cerebral cortex for
'il--' reference. Figure 11.6 (c) shows cerebrum with trantal, parietel,
''lr- eoral and occipital four cobes etc. General functional relationship
' brain parts are as follows:
Breathing, heart rate and kidney functions are controlled through
ud
Super or
Diencephalon
I
l
ria
_-e Posterior
Infs1i91 +
Ventral
ate
l/ledulla oblongata
I
lnferior
Caudal
Cerebellum
yM
t.: Fig. 11.6. (a) Cut-way view of the human brain
I
*
Peripheral nerve
Fourth ven
Spinal cord
ud
Third ventricle
Pulr
Thalamocortical radiations
St
Fig. 11.6. (b) Ce;'ebrai cortex and sor-ne activlty center therein
Prirnary mctor
corlex
(precentral Post central
gyrus)
" gyrus (general
l
sensory projection
ria
Vision
ate
Vision
association
area
Hearing
association area
Vasomotor nerves
Bronchus
Lymphatics
ud
l-ymphatics
St
(uii
/V/V\/V AAA
l
/*\
ria
AAAA
IX
X
*ll,'r^
XI
^'Ar\/v
ate
Vagi intact Vagi cut
External
forces
yM
c Control Muscular I +
signal +
force
y-Dynamic
control Fig.
signal
y-Static
control
signal
ud
Fig. 11.8. Block diagram of peripheral motor control system The dashed line
indicates the non-neural feedback from muscle that limits length and velocity via the
inherent mechanical properties of muscle. rd, dynamic r motor neurons rs, static r
motor neurons
(u) Reticular activation system (RAS) is non-specific sensory portior: 4
which surrounds the thalamus. When aroused, it alerts the cerebria:
cortex which makes it sensitive to incoming information. RAS keeps S
a person awake.
St
l
pressure, touch, etc., frontal lobe for primary motor neurons leading
ria
to various muscles of the body, preferential lobe for neurons of eye
movement control, temporal lobe for responding to various
frequencies of audotory nature.
Apomorphine, digitails
glycosides, copper sulphate
Chemoreceptor
trigger zone
ate
Vomiting
center
l0l
{
Vagal E
afferents
yM
lrritation
of mucosa
Fig. 11.9. (a) Afferent pathways for the vomiting reflex, showing the chemoreceptor
trigger zone in the medulla
SENSORY MOTOR
ud
St
v; I
J?i
J
Page No. 188Fig. 328. (b) Human sensory and motor functions
of 11.9.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
11 .s. NEURAL COMMUNICATION
When neurons are excited, they generate action potentials. These action
potentials are of very short duration and are transmitted in the form of
spike discharge patterns. Figure 11.10(a). shows spike discharge pattern
from a single neuron of a cat. These are responsible for motor functions.
The sequence of spikes are transmitted down a particular neural pathway.
Figure 11.10(b) shows a burst pattern. Action potential of neuron is
ate
propagated down the axon to the axiom terminals where it can be
transmitted to other neurons. The neurons can be transmitted to other
neurons. The neurons can be triggered at any point along the dendrites,
cell body or axon. Due to the natural functions of neurons, the
cornmunication is only one way. Some of the important aspects of neural
communication are as follows:
yM
I .:'
neuron firing depends on the net effect of all the axons interactinE : tt(
-,-ar
with it, see figure 11.11(a).
(10 Potentials of the receiving neurons are graded and it reaches a _ ttf
---5
certain threshold; the neuron fires and action potential develops - -:l(
The action potential of a given neurons are same. An excitoq- :
l
at axon terminal
ria
Postsynaptic
dendrite membrane
ate
Antagonistic chemical Chemical transmitter
in gap breaks down is released from
transmitter during re axon terminal and
fractory period of quickly fills gap
membrane
Arrival of chemical trans
Unless inhibilited, membr ane potential mitter causes potential
change leads to generation of action change in postsynaptic
potential in postsynaptic neuron dendrite membrane d
prolactin
ft/otor nerves Motor nerves Juxta- Adrenal Anterior Posterior
to skeletal to smooth and glomerular medulla pituitary pituitary
muscle cardiac muscle
ud
cells
Fig. 11.11. (b) Neural control mechanisms. ln the two situations on the left,
neurotransmitters act at nerve endings on muscles; in the two in the middle,
'reurotransmitters, regulate the secretion of endocrine glands; and in the two on the
right, neurons secrete hormones into the hypophysial portal or general circulation.
Inhibitory axon causes a graded potential (IPSP) in the receiving
reurons which is more negative than the normal resting potential,
.herefore, it requires a greater amount cf excitation than normal resting
:otential. Inhibiting axon action is also possible based an excitary
St
l
(lil) The sequence of events during chemical transmission across a E
ria
axon terminal and chemical transmitter is released from axon J
terminal and quickly falls gap as shown in the figure. Arrival of
chemical transmitter caltses potential change in post synaptic I
C
dendrite membrane. The antagonistic chemical in gap breaksdown
transmitter during refractory period of membrane. It is not inhibited,
membrane potential change leads to generation of action potential S
in post synaptic rreuron.
ate
Sense Afferent Synapse Efferent Neuromuscular Muscle
organ neuron neuron junction I
(lr
__-r\_ ___-/-\_-
Genrator EPSPs
potential (and IPSPs) -,.$/
yM
{lr
*il
Fig. 11.11. (c) EPSP and ,\,,1
Figures lr.l2(a) and 1\.r2(b). show correlation between behavioural
states; awake and sleeps patterns.
Thalamocortical loop Single cell propertise
F
Pyramidal cells 30-50 Hz
Awake Tonic firing gamma oscillations itt
Airtl^l1Adt/irt
20-80 Hz rhythms
'1 .6.
Cerebral cortex
ud
'-,lL
Thalamocortical cell
0.54 Hz burst firing Tonic firing r,_: S
{
Deep sleep
, .^ t,
Thalamus
rl- ..fl
St
.a(
.. ,--L
--L
Transition from steps to waking
O.54 Hz rhythms :h
Fig. 11 .12. (a) Correlation between behavioral states, EEG, and single cell r-:--1
responses in the cerebral cortex and thalamus.
Page No. 191 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Nervous System 193
Awake
ff*..-.Al-q*^rrf ,f"-,"-"-J,f,
l
1
EMG
ria
CENTRAL
FRONTAL
:;;F;+,,..k!e,."r*v '--^v
^
OCCIP
Stage 2 (50 pv, 10-14H2)
ate
ffi--+r-a.fra
*-."./.*{"fl\r-.g I^f rr"'-w*aryr^'-*'...
-jt Vf7/,-ff^**--+*-+""(*-"r'*
,v,.*r'r-.q-ar,V^.-l,r t 6',
/u'.*-&!
.d-i.$@ @,+/Frv+-
Stage 3 Stage 4
(lncreased amplitude & Lower,frequency) (Maximum slowing with Large waves)
v:,rr.r*j \A'rr\nru"f+r,-r^"'t1,,fu.,\1i"rAJ,l'.,ft .rrr{v+!.,-d,
,if.A.n_! Vf$/v' r/l$.Vh^f,4v,a / o\"1 ti',,- 1 o 1"
IrV
j1',i.;;''
yM
\J'lv,t/j\l\(rn' u'tt r'\.,1r,','.r\i
1 l/1I so
;F,,\r+v-. V
',^'',/,,*"S'
2s
Fig. 11 .12. (b) EEG and muscle activity during various stages of steep, EOG,
= eitro-oculogram
registering eye movements; EMG, electromyogram registering
skeletal muscle activity: CENIRA, RONIAL, OCCIP, three EEG leads
-::rough the effects of the nervous system on other systems of the body.
. re individual neurons can be stimulated electrically. The muscle
:,ovement Centre is measured. Care must be taken to ensure that neurons
':e stimulated similar to natural stimulation
A gross nerve hring measurement is done when electrode of larger
-:.an 0.1 mm in diameter is placed near a nerve of a large number of
::urons. It gives summation of the action potentials from all neurons
,:ound the electrode. Single neurons action potential can be seen either
St
l
height is about 60 millivolts. Each division is 0.5 milliseconds. some of
the important aspects of neuronal firing measurements are as follows:
ria
(z) The penetrating an individual cell is limited to some speciarized
cells involving only large type of cells. The microelectrodes with tips
of about 1o mm in diameter is used for extracellular measurements
and about 1 mm for intracellular measurements are used.
ti
rl
I ate
Fig. 11'13. (a) Gross measurement of multiple unit neuronal discharge. Time span is
500 msec., having maximum peak to peaks amplitude of 150 microvolts
(li) Neuronal firing measurements range from hundreds microvolts for
single neuron in extracellular measurements to about 1oo mv for
intracellular measurements. Due to the short duration of neurona]
spikes, the amplifier should have frequency response from belos- ilrl
iu)
l
c
t
yM
7 Hz to many thousand Hz.
(iid Ordinary pen recorders are used for recording or display. Ar: clocl
oscilloscope with a camera for photographing the spike patterns or Ap
a high speed light galvanometer or an electrostatic recorder is ::nec
used for measurements. r tfat
::ctor
Sub
!-: ga
--:noI
=- po'
fror
ud
_:s o
---le r
--\ens
- ,:plie
:m/
s:gni
a-e L
--s tir
St
:-: --trol
::2. I
::en
[+_ZZOp,sec___, :._:ltm
Fig. 11.13. (b) Gross measurement of multiple unit neuronal discharge of 500 r--- ac
width The peak amplitude is 150 microsecs :=d t
Page No. 193 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Nervous System 195
l
ria
\
\
J
ate
Fig. 11.13. (c) Extracellular measurement of unit discharge from
red nucleus of an animal
iu) For nerve condition time or velocity, the nerve is stimulated.
Potentials are measured from another nerve or from a muscle
actuated by the stimulated nerve. The oscilloscope helps to get the
difference of time between stimulus and the net firing measured on
the oscilloscope.
,ntrolled by the high frequency filter having values 15, 30, TO and
Hz. EEG machine haves a notch filter tuned at 50 Hz to eliminate
r-erence from the frequency of the main power line. EEG are selected
:inimum noise which is specified as peak-to-peak value.
rr accurate and stable paper drive mechanism is needed which
-Jed by a synchronous motor. Speeds of 15, 30 and 60 mm/sec are
Page No. 194 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
ate :C(
:las.
..ho,
-r tl
yM
Analog to :ld
Digital lnverter
I tnt<=writins I I Chart I
I oscilloqraPh | 1 drlve I
ud
l
F = Frontal
C = Central
ria
T = Temporal
T5 T6 O = Occipital
P = Parietal
P3 P4 A = Ear Common
A1 A2
c3 c2 C4
F3 F4
FP1 FP2
(
L
yM
l
&flr
of the EEG amPlifiers. det
ria
Rhlthmical potentials are generated by brain. These potential originate als
from individual neurons of the brain. The waveform pattern is
complex is termed electro-encephalogram (EEG). The millions of the cells
discirarge synchronousl5' t"6 get summed up for the net generated
potential.
The neuons are electrically polarized, at rest similar to other cells'
The neuron has potential of -70 mV with respect to the exterior'
When
a nerve impulse
a neuron is subjected' to a stimulus (above threshold)'
ate
due to change in membrane potential is generated which spreads
in the
tepolatization takes
celt. This depolarizes the cell and shortly afterwards
place.
The signal of EEG are taken from electrodes either from scalp or
,F
clirectly from ttre cerebral cortex. The peak to peak amplotude
is 100 mY
t
if picked up from cerabral cortex' The frequency varies from 0'5 Hz lo
50 Hz. The basic frequency of EEG is classihed into hve band for
analysis t
.t
pu-rposes:
'l
Delta 0.5H2-4Hz I
- 4Hz-8Hz r
yM
Theta
- 8Hz-13Hz a
*i Alpha
L
Reta
-13H2-22H2
22Hz-30Hz
b
Gamma
- alertness of the brain which serves as indicato: S
Alpha rhyttrm indicates rA
summarisec
of anaesthe"i" i.r the operating room. The waveforms can be k
as follo'*'s: cl
\!'\"'j
, o'5 - 4 Hz Premature bab: br
-\ sleePing adults a1
ud
children and fu
Theta waves "i.r'\-'i*'\"'\s*')'d"'\*--r\*!''t"* 4 - 8 Hz
SleePing adults at
sy
m
gL
-It
th,
Under normal conditions there is generally inverse relationsh of
between amplitude and frequertcy, i'e', if frequency reduces' the
ampliturr
St
Ce
increases. The increased cirabral activity leads to more desynchron
an
activity of the nerve cells. col
Spikes and waves of abnormal shape occur during attacks of epile brz
The extinction or damping of electrical activity in the cortex can be rWt
to tumor. The tumor pi""i." on the neurons and destroys them.
ox-\'
deficiency due to circulatory disturbance similar to bleeding would I act
Page No. 197 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
cause similar problem. Earlier damages present in the cortex in the form
of tumors or scars, may generate abormal electrical activity.
EEG is used for examination of epilepsy, brain damage, brain tumors
and other organic brain injuries. There is occassional use of EEG for
l
determination of level of consciousness 1.e., depth of anaesthesia. It can
ria
also establish death of brain.
ate
a high communication network which links all parts of the body. It
is also responsible for the behaviour of the organism leading to
autonomy and acquires valious traits which characterise as an
individual.
Neuron or soma is the basic unit of the r-r.ervous system. Neuron is
a single cell body having one or more dendrites input fibers and the
axon, i.e., a long transmitting Iiber. Some types of neurons have
axons or denoted coating of a fatty insulating material known as L
l
membrane of the receiving neuron'
6.
ria
11.1
.1.1
-1.1
- i.1
1.1',
measurements. Ord.inary pen recorders are used'
ate
7. A pattern of electrodes on the head and the channels
where they are 1.1t
connected is known as Montage which is symmetrical. EEG signals
1.1!
-2C
lt
arxerCi,te,J
Communication.
11.2. How neuronal firing measurements are made? Explain EPSP and IPS?
(UPTU, 20ia'
11.3. Give the block diagram of EtrG. How diagnosis is made with trEG?
(uPTU, 20'-1*
1,1.4. Give anatomy of nervous system' What is neuronal commnnicatic---:
(LrPTU, 2o.a:
Describe trMG.
ll.5.trxplaintheworkingprincipleofEEG?DrawablockdiagrarnofEE..
St
(UPTU, IIIC.P
11.10. Explain the way in which a neuronal spike is transmitted from one
neuron to another.
i 1.1 1. What are the nodes of Ranvier and what useful purpose do they serve?
11.12. What is a spinal reflex, and how is it related to the functions of the
l
brain?
ria
i 1.13. What are graded potentials?
11.14. What is a neuronal spike? Draw a typical spike showing amplitude and
duration.
-1.15. How does the action of the synrpathetic nervous system differ from that
of the parasy'rnpathetic system? Quote an example from the body.
- i.16. Explain the physiologr of nervous system. Write the factors affecting the
neuronal communication. (UPTU. MQP)
1.17. Explain with example EPSP and IPSP. Write the applications trMG for
human. (UPTU, MQP)
ate
-1.18. Give the block diagram of EEG. Explain its; Rythms. Ho'.v is it helpful in
diagnosis? (UPTU, 2004)
--.19. Explain the neuronal communication. Gitze the autonomy of nervous
systems. (UPTU, 20Os)
Explain neuronal firing and how it can be rneasured? Explain EPSP and
IPSP. (UPTU, 2OOs)
I'
JAJ E
yM
ud
St
l
ria
Opthalmologlr Instruments
and lens of the eye, ln inverted image is formed on the retina of the er-t
'lhe rods and cones of photoreceptors consists of rods and cone:
These are distinguisleed by their shape and functions. These are shotr=
in figure 12.2. ar
202 CC
.h
Page No. 201 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Posterior
Chamber
l
Anterior
ria
chamber
Optic
nerve
Visual
axts
ate
Aqueous
humour
l-
Viterous
humour
(
Fig. 12.1, The eye c
J
yM
\/
Shelves of folded
membrane
/S'_.-'-
Outer
segment
lnner
segment
oo
Qo
ud
Synaptic
regron
b9;oo 1o o o -\
St
l
100
n
ria
c)
o Th
c
C6
-o re'l
bso
o (
-o
G
.C (
: (
ate
Wavelength (nm)
a
Optic tract Lateral
:l
Optic
, radjator
:/
ud
and relays the sensations to the brain via visual pathways which comprise
optic nerve, optic tract, and optic radiations. The pathways are shown
in figare 72.4.
l
ELECTROPHYSIOLOGICAL TESTS
ria
The electrophysiological tests of the eye allow objective evaluation of the
retinal functions. These include
(a) Electroretinogrphy (ERG)
(b) Electrooculography (EOG)
(c) Visually Evoked Response (VER)
ate
Electroretinogram (ERG) is a measure of response of the retina of the
:-ve to light i.e., changes in the resting potential of the eye from darkness
:o fall of light on the retina. ERG signals are more complex as compared
rerve exon signai because it is the sum of many effects taking place
*'ithin the eye. The amplitude range of ERG signal is 0.5 mV to 1 mV
end frequency from DC to 20 Hz.
The electroretinogram is composite electrical activity from the photo L
:eceptors (cones) and poterior poles of the eye and is known as cornea
. etinal potential which changes with the action of light on the retina.
)
\t rest the potential difference is 6 mv between cones and poterior pole.
yM
Normal record of ERG consists of the following waves which may be
;een in figure i2.5.
. a-wave : Initial negative wave from photoreceptors (rods and cones)
. b-wave : Large cornea-positive wave generated by Miller cells, but
represents the activity of bipolar cells.
. c-wave : It is also a positive wave with lower amplitude representing
metabolic activity of pigment epithelium.
c-wave
ud
I (proton get
o positive)
D
E
o-
E
Light stumulus
Figure i2.6 ERG component dip in the lower line shown the application
:,::nt of light stimulus.
Amplitude of a-wave is measured from the base line to the through
:: the a-wave whereas that of b-wave is measured from through of a-
,r ,r'e to peak of b-wave. Similarly, whole measuring the sequences in the
l?G wave, Latency is the time interval between start of light stimulus
Page No. 204 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
b-wave implicit tim
ria
I
o amplitude
E
E
-a-Wave
+
E-
E lmpact time
;h
lr
it
Fig. 12.6.
ate
rnc colrponent
In humans the ERG signals are recorded with one electrode is fited
on the cornea and is normally embedded in a contact lens one .other
Dip
Cornea
it is
Transparent the
contact lens isoli
Anterior chamber
etc.
slgni
Fat-bone medium
of eye orbit rang
A
:nedi
T
and r
Fig. 12.7. The transparent contact lens contains one electrode, shown here on rn th
horizontal section of the right eye. Reference electrode is placed on the right tempe
St
.s at
The arrangement of recording ERG of the eye may be seen ::- :trai
figure 12.8. :ioser
The ERG is recordeC both in the lights adapted (photopic) and da:L T1
adapted (scotopic) states. In photopic ERG patient is tested with ligl-: .ight
condition to suppress rod response. Only one response (5 to 8 millic- ray
cones) is elicited giving lower amplitude and shorter implicit time. O: :lOVCI
Page No. 205 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
the other hand in scotopic ERG with dark adaptation, large amolitude
with longer implicit time is available. Here both cones (6 - g million) and
rods (125 million) contribute to response.
l
Reference
Electrode
ria
ate
ERG
signal
l
Eye wets
0" usual
ria
angle
1
(
t
o
V
ate
Resting potential of eye
for a- period of 12 minutes. The recording is done first in the dark itr
adapted stage and then repeated in light adapted stage.
The results of EOG are interpreted by hnding out the Arden ratio as
follows:
Maximum height of light peak x 100
Arden Ratio =
Maximum height of dark through
(o) Normal curye values are 185 or more.
St
l
ria
OPHTHALMOSCOPE
Ophthalmoscope is a clinical examination of the interior of the eye by
means of an ophthalmoscopy. It is primarily done to assess the conduction
of fundus and defect the opacities of ocular media. The cphthalmoscope
was invented by Von Helmholtz in 1850. Three method of examination
are ln use:
(a) Distant Direct Ophthalmoscope (DDO)
ate
(b) Direct Ophthalmoscpy
(c) Indirect Ophthalmoscopy.
12.3.1. Distant Direct Ophthalmoscopy (DDO)
It should be performed routinely before the direct ophthalmoscopy
and gives a lot of useful information. It can be performed with the help
of a self-illuminated ophthalmoscope or a simple plain mirror with a hole
in the centre.
The light is thrown in the patient's eye siting in a semi-darkroom
from a distance of 20-25 cm and the features of the red glow in the
yM
pupillary area are noted.
With the help of distant direct ophthalmoscopy the following defects
in the eye are detected.
To diagnose the opacities in the refractive media. Any opacity in the
refractive media is seen as a black shadow in the red glow. The exact
location can be determined by observing parallactic displacement. For
exact location of the opacity can be determined by observing the parallactic
displacement. For this the patient is asked to more the eye up and down
while the Doctor (observer) is observing the pupillary glow. The opacity
in the pupillary plain remain stationary, those in front of the pupillary
plain more in the direction of the movement of the eye and those behind
ud
l
If is the most common method for routine fundus examination. The
modern direct ophthalmoscope shown in figure 12.11 works on the
ria
optical principle of glass plate ophthalmoscope invented by Von Helmholtz.
Optics of direct ophthalmoscopy is depicted in hgure 12.12.
ate 12.3.
now
Ir
yM
T]
righll
Fig. 12.11. Direct Ophthalmoscope
:hat t
A convergent beam of light is reflected to the patient pupil shown by asal
dotted lines in figure 12.12. The emergent rays from any point on the :ye w
patient's fundus reach the observer's (Doctor's) retina through the viewing Tt
hole in the ophthalmoscope. This is shown by continuous lines in the :lagnr
figure 12.12. The emergent rays from the patient's eye are paralle1 and -ens,
brought to focus on the retina of the patient's eye, when accommodation ragnl
is relaxed. However if patient orf and the Doct-or is/are amtropic a :i]age
correcting lens (equivalent to the sum of the patient's and Doctor's
refractive error) must be interposed (from the system of plus and minus
ud
EE. M rror
-E
l
ria
Patient Eye Observer
(Doctor's eye)
\i
+
E
St
Patient's eye
Convex lens
Fig. 12.13. Optics of indirect ophthalmoscopy
Page No. 210 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
212 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
l
distant (with the self illuminated ophthalmoscope).
In practice binocular ophthalmoscope with head band or mounted on
ria
the spectacle frame, is employed most frequently keeping his eyes on
the reflex the examiner then interposes the condensing lens (+20 DS,
routinely) in the path of beam of light, close to patient's eye and then
slowly moves the lens away from the eye (towards examiner's or Doctor's)
until the image of the retina is clearly seen. The examiner moves around
the head of the patient to examine different quadrants of the fundus.
The indirect ophthalmoscopy is essential for the assessment and
ate
management of retinal detachment and other retinal problems.
The technique of indirect ophthalmoscopy is difficult and cannot be
mastered without much practice.
The advantage of the indirect ophthalmoscopy is the in built
illumination is strong and its intensity can be changed. It allows
lr!
stereoscopic view of the image.
4
12.4. TONOMETER FOR EYE PRESSURE MEASUREMENT
The intraocular pressure (IOP) is measured with the help of an instrument
yM
u
called tonometer. Two basic types of tonometers available are Identation
b (Schlotz) Tonometer and Applanation (Goldmann) Tonometer.
12.4.1. ldentation (Schlotz) Tonometer
Schlotz tonometer shown in figure 12.14 consist of (a) handle fo:
holdings the instrument vertical position on the cornea (b) a foot plate z 4.2.
which rest on the cornea (c) plunger which moves inside the foot plate Thi
(d) bent lever whose short lever rest on plunger and long arm acts as ::n I
a pointer needle. The degree to which plunger indents the cornea is .of
indicated by the movement of needle on a scale. (e) 5 gm is permanentli Jor
fixed to the plunger and is increased to 7.5 or 1O gm. -l: -}
ud
The foot plate of Schlotz tonometer and lever of the plunger shoul.c
be sterilized in hot water for 30 minutes.
The eye whose intraocular eye pressure is to be measured :s
anesthizing the cornea by 2'k topical xylocane, patient is made to lie c-
a couch. The tonometer is held in the left hand and the -ioot plate ;"
made to rest on the cornea. The reading on the scale is recorded by r-:t
needle becomes steady.
It is customery to start with a -weight of 5 gm. However if the sca"le
St
reading is less than 1' then the weight may be increased to 7.5 gm :E
10 gm. If weight is increased then a conversion table should be use:
The advantage of using Schlotz tonometer is that it is very hanrt
The main disadvantage is that it cannot be used in abnormal h:!m
pressure.
l
ria
ate \''t
yM
':1..'
I
St
l
1
I
5
l
\\ n
ria
b
L
D
1n
pr
8
AT
T}
ate
Nr
+. o1
th
Th
F an
0
Th
op
1
It
t,
Fig.' 1 2.1 4. Technique of applanatlon tonometry Th
opl
yM
t C-i
ex
qui
Ini
strr
frot
Doc
abc
1nv(
Fig. 12.15. Showlng end point of app-lanation tonometry; by,
(A) too smail; (B) too large; (C) end point
The
mar
ud
,12.5.1SUMMARY Ton
tEo
l.AnatomyofVision:Eyeisanopticalsystemwhichfocusesligh''i
photo receptors and has a system-of nerves *11:^,:"11Y::: '*:i
The
is a clear bic \pp
from the receptors to the brain' Lens in an eye
ligament kno
structure behind the pupil held by circular lens
The
shol
zonule. )o/
Each eyeball acts as a cornea, it pelceives the
imSF:" 1 /O
which i1*:ii::
St
l
not possible. The eye movement of rnore than 30" do not produce
ria
bioelectric amplitudes that are strictly proportioned to the eye position.
Light peak represent the maximal height of the potential in light.
Dark through represent the level of minimal height of the potential
in darkness. Normally the resting potential of the eye decreases
progressively during dark adaptation reaching to dark through in
8 to 12 minutes. In the light adaptation the amplitude start rising
and reaches a light peak in 6-9 minute.
The result of EOG are interpreted by finding out the Arden ratio.
ate
Normal Arden values are 185 or more.
a. Ophthalmoscope: The ophthalmoscopy is primarily done to assess
the condition of fundus and detect the opacities of ocular media.
There are two types of ophthalmoscopy. The Direct ophthalmoscopy
and Indirect ophthalmoscopy.
The distant direct ophthalmoscopy is done by self illuminated
ophthalmoscopy or a simple plain mirror with a hole in the centre.
It is used to detect opacities in the refractive media.
This method is also useful to detect detached retina. The direct
ophthalmoscopy is very useful and is routinely done by the Doctor's.
yM
C-ice the light beam is focused on the retina the details should be
examined systematically starting from the blood vessels, the form
quadrant of the general background.
In indirect ophthalmoscopy the eye is made highly myopic by placing
strong convex lens in front of patient's eye so that the emergent rays
irom an area is focused as an inverted image between lens and the
Doctor's eye. The image formed in indirect ophthalmoscopy is real,
:nverted and magnified. Magnihcation is about 5 times and is achieved
f,ya+13Dlens.
The indirect ophthalmoscopy is essential for the assessment and
:rranagement of retinal detachments and other retinal problems.
ud
oxercded
12.1. Explain Electro Retinogram (ERG). (UPTU, 2004)
72.2. Dxplain Electrooculogram.
l
(UPTU, 2OO4)
12.3. Describe Ophthalmoscope. (UPTU, 200s, 2006)
ria
72.4. Explain Tonometer for eye pressure measurement. (wTU, 200s, 2006)
12.5. Explain the working principle of Electro-retinogram with block diagram.
(UPTU-MQP)
12.6. Name the instrument for measurement of eye pressure and explain with
diagram in detail. (UPTU-MQPI
AJJ
ate )9.
13
13.
13.
13.
yM
13.
13. r
I10
|
U-
l1
r 3.1.
.reat i
,ud a
ud
-Ieat l
r-- ihe
.L:-d fai
qi the
brdv tr
ri-iS 1S
::h th
per,
St
The
:lorn
3-37
pera
Page No. 215 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
Some General Topics
TEMPERATURE
:--:at is produced in the body by assimilation of food, muscular exercise
::-d all the vital processes that contribr,rte to the basal metabolic rate.
ud
l
temperature is normally 0.5"C lower than the rectal temperature, but it ter
ria
is affected by many factors, including ingestion of hot or cold fluid3, gum 1S
chewing, smoking and mouth breathing. alr
In human, the normal temperature undergoes a regular circadian tra
fluctuation of 0.5-0.7"C. The individuals who sleep at night and are rvh
awake during the day, it is the lowest at about 6 AM and highest in the rnd
evenings. During sleep it is lowest. It is slightly higher in the awake :VC
state but relaxed state, it rises with activity. In the case of women, owing :lea
to ol.ulation, there is an additional monthly cycle of temperature variation :ffe
ate
characterized by a rise in basal temperature. In young children, -igh
temperature regulation is less precise and they may normally have a
temperature which is about 0.5'C above the established form for adults. he
The heat produced by muscular contraction gets accumulated in the :em
t
body, during exercise, and the rectal temperature rises as high as 40'C Ita
(104"F). This rise is due to in part to the inability of the heat dissipating .cI
to handle the greatly increased amount of heat product. But there is an :IlVl
al
evidence that in addition there is an deviation of body temperature at ',
apc
which the heat dissipating mechanisms are activated during exercise. r:lVli
Rise in body temperature can take place by emotional excitement, probabll-
yM
_1e
g) owing to unconscious tensing of muscles. Chronic elevation by 0.5"C apo
occurs when the metabolic rate is high and lowered whether metabolic ::lV1I
rate is low. Few normal adults chromically have a temperature above the ::cli
normal range.
' 3.1 .,
13.1.2. Heat Production
T
A variety of chemical reactions contributed to body heat production ::e 1r
at all times. The major source of heat is the contraction of skeletal .clur
muscle. Endocrine mechanisms can vary heat production in the absence -rSpC
of food intake or muscular exertion. A slowly developing but prolonged
increase in temperature is attributed to thyroid harmones. The source ' eict
::laf,
of heat in infants, is brown fat. This fat has a high rate of metabolism.
ud
- : SpOr
it's thermogenic function is like an electric blanket. -:los
13.1.3. Heat Loss Bc
: _:vel
Heat is lost from the body when the environmental temperature is :-:c c
below the body temperature. The processes by which heat loss takes
place is listed below in the Table 13.1.
Table 13.1. Body Heat Production and Heat Loss Me
St
Inc
Body heat is lost by Percentage of heat
lost at 21'C
Radiation and conduction 70
Vapourization of sweat
Respiration 2
Page No. Urination and defecation
217 of 328. I
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
:emperatures that are in contact with one another. when an individual
ria
:s in a cold environment, heat is lost by conduction to the surrounding
air and by radiation to cool objects in the vicinity. conversely, heat is
rransferred to al individual and the heat load is increased by the processes
',r'hen the environmental temperature
is above body temperature. An
:ndividual can feel chilly in a room with cold walls blcause of radiation
:ven though the room is relatively warm. on a cold but sunny days the
:eat of the sun reflected off bright objects exerts an appreciabll warming
:ffect. The heat reflected from the snow makes skin possible in fairly
ate
:ght clothes even though the air temperature is below freezing.
The other major heat transfer process in hurnans is vapourization of
:ee water in the form of sweat on the skin. vapourization of 1 g of water
:.moves about 0.6'c kcal of heat. A certain amount of water is vapourized
=tt all times. This water loss amounts to 50 ml/h in humans. ThL degree
r which the sweat vapourizes depends upon the humidity of 1ne
=:rvironment, when the sweat secretion is increased. Decreased
apourization of sweat leads one to feel hotter on a humid day. As the
::rvironmental temperature changes, the relative contribution of each of
-re processes that transfer heat away from body
also changes. The
yM
apourization is a minor component in humans at rest at 21"c. As the
=rvironmental temperature approaches body temperature, radiation losses
::cline and vapourization losses increase.
' 3.1.4.Temperature Regulating Mechanisms
The reflex and semi-reflex thermoregulatory responses in humans
r--e mechanisms activated by, hot and cold as shown in
Table 13.2. They
-clude autonomic somatic, endocrine and behavioural changes. ThL
-:spcnses which increase heat loss and
decrease heat production and
i:rich decrease heat loss and increase heat production rnay be grouped
'.carately. In general, exposure to heat stimulates the former group of
ud
l
Cutaneous vasoconstriction
Mechanisms Activated BY Heat
ria
Increase Heat Loss
Sweating
Increased respiration
Cutaneous vasodilation
Decrease Heat Production
Anorexia
Apathy and inerti.a
ate
Examples includ.e dancing up and down and foot stamping on a cold
day. An important end.ocrine response to cold is increased catecholamine
secretion. Thermoregulatory adjustments involve local responses as well
as more general reflex responses. Cutaneous blood vessels become more
+
I
sensitive to catecholamines and arterioles and venules constrict when
bloocl vessels are cooled. This local effect of cold directs blood away from
the skin.
The reflex responses activated by cold are controlled from the posterior
I
j
hypothalamus. Activated by warmth, they are controlled primarily fron:
: the interior hypothalamus although some thermoregulation against hea:
yM
l\ still occurs after decerebration at the load of the postal midbrain
Stimulation of the anterior hypothalamus causes cutaneous vasodilatior
and sweating and lessons in this region cause hyperthermia, with recta-
temperatures sometimes reaching 43"C (109.4'F).
13.1.5. Afferents
The hypothalamus integrates body temperature information fro=
sensory receptors (primarily cold creptors) in the skin, deep tissues c: refc
spinal cord, extra hyperthermic portions of the brain, and hypothalamus len
itself. Each of these contributes about 2Ook of the information that :s
-4r11
l
addition to this, antibody production is increased, when body temperature
ria
is elevated.
Endotoxin
lnflammation other
pyrogenetic stimuli
ate
Monocytes
Maerophages
Kuffler cells
Cytokines
Prepic area
of hypothalamus
Prostaglandins
Raise temperature
yM
set point
Fever
l
record.ing and greater accuracy of temperature is needed' more
ria
sophisticated measuring instruments must be used'
Care must be taken to rninimize current through the thermocouple
circuit, for the current not only causes heating at the junction but also
additional error due to the Peltier effect, wherein one junction is warmed
and other is cooled'
Inthermistors,therelationshipbet'"lreenresistancechangeand
temperature change is non-linear. To overcome this, the instrumentation
oftenincorporatesspeciallinearizingcircuits'Itmaybeapairofmatched
ate
errors
thermistors as part o f ltnearizatron circuit. Thermistors also have
duetoself-heating,hysteresis,aging,therefore,suitablemeasuresareto
be taken to minimrze error. Most thermistors thermometers
use a wheat s
,1
temperatu-re variations. The bridge is balanced at some reference
temperatureandcalibratedtoread'variationsaboVeandbelowthat I
refeience. Either ac or dc excitation can be used for the bridge.
i.
(
4 (
Lg.|.7.2. Skin Temperature Measurements t
Skin temperature can vary several degrees from one point to another'
1-
: C
yM
Therangeisformabout30to35"C(85to95"F).Exposuretoancient 1.
tt temperJures, the covering of fact over capillary areas' and the local r.
the
blood circulation pattern are some of the factors which influence t.
distribution of temperatures over the surface of the body.inSkin the
)
temperatur" -"."rr.-ents can be used to defect or locate defects C
given stimulus. a
Another method is based. on infrared radiation trrrd temperature S
l
gonads at the time of birth cause the appearance of features typical of
ria
the adult male or female and onset of the sexual cycle in the female. The
ovarian function regresses after a number of years, in femaies and
sexual cycles cease, i.e., menopause occurs. In males, there is a slow
declinein gonadal function with advancing age, but ability to father a
child persists.
The gonads have a dual functionality in both the sexes-the secretion
of sex hormones and the production of germ cells.
ate
13.2.1. Sex Differentiation and Development
Chromosomes determine the sex. The sex Genetic determination of
sex is done by two chromosomes called the sex chromosomes to
distinguish them from the somatic chromosomes. The sex chromosomes
are called X and Y chromosomes. The Y chromosome is necessary for the
production of testes. The tastes determining gene product is called SRY
(Sex-determining region of the Y-chromosome). SRY is a DNA
(beoxyribanualicacid) i.e., a giant molecule binding regulatory protein. It
bends the DNA and acts as a transcription factor. It initials transcription
of a cascade of genes necessary for testicular differentiation. It also
yM
includes the gene for MIS (Mullerian lnhibiting Substance). With deploid
number of chromosomes, male cells contain an X and Y chromosome
i.e., XY pattern, whereas female cells contain two X chromosomes i.e.,
-XX pattern. During gametigonesis, due to meiosis, each normal ovum
contains a single X chromosome. But half the normal sperms contain an
X chromosome and half contain a Y chromosome XY pattern results
rvhen a sperm containing a Y-chromosomes fertilizers an or,,r-rm. And
zvgote develops into a genetic male. XX pattern and a genetic female
:esults when fertilization occurs with an X containing sperm. A primitive
gonad arises from the genital ridge a condensation of tissue near the
adrenal gland on each side of the embryo. The gonad develops a cortex
ud
.nd a medulla. These structures are identical in both the sexes until the
=rxth week of development. The medulla develops into the testes during
.re seventh and eight week. And the cortex regresses. Testosterone and
=-iller ion inhibiting substance are secreted and leydig and Sertoli cells
.:art appearing. The cortex, in the case of genetic females develops into
n:-r. ovary and the medulla regresses. The embryonic differentiation of
=-a-le
and female internal genetical ducts is shown in figure 13.2.
St
Fo
pa
of
C1I
l
Mesonephros
ria
Gonadal ligament
Wolffian duct
Mlillerian ligament Sym
Uterovaginal
canal Ur
Bladder
ate
Epididymis
Urogenital sinus
Vas
deferens
Uterine tube
INDIFFERENT I
Ovarian ligament ji ::eCt
Gubernaculum
: iocl
_:.teg
yM
Seminal
t vesicle --:1pu
::eCt:
:f 1na
-:eth
-:eth
Gartner's ducl -_-_at
l
:_--l-ert
Er
j.i:lTIe
:- JSCI
MALE FEMALE :- :he
ud
:tr::leti
Fig. 13.2. Embryonic differentiation of male and female internal genitalia (genital i. aal
ducts) from male and female primordia. ir_: 1o.
'I:'.'ef
13.2.2. Male Reproductive System t
? i t-.'e s
The yenter through the ejaculatory ducts into the urethra in the bod_, ,r, ni
of the prostrate at the time of ejaculation, see of figure 13.3. There arr :=
nests of cells between the tubules in the testis containing lipid granules - '-'t /
the interstitial cells of leydig, which secrete testesterone into bloodstrear::- - --at
Page No. 223 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Some General Topics 225
Fortons are spermatic arteries to the testes, and blood in them runs
parallel but in the opposite direction to blood in the pampiniferm plexus
of spermatic veins. This anatomic arrangement may permit counter
current exchange of heat and testosterone.
l
Bladder Ureter
ria
Vas deferens
Head of epididymis
\
Symphysis
Prostate
Urethra *
Seminiferous
tubules
Ejaculatory duct
ate
Epididymis
./'
Cowper's ',/
- (bulbourethral) gland Tunica albuginea
I
Scrotum Tail of epididymis
(a) (b)
Fig. 13.3(a) Male reproductive system. (b) Duct system of the testis F
Dilation of the arterioles of the penis results in an erection. As the
::ectile tissue of the penis fills with blood, the veins are compressed,
-locking outflow and adding to the turgor of the organ. Activation of the
,ltegrating centres in the lumbar segments of the spinal cord is done by
yM
-npulses in afferents from the genitalia and descending tracts that mediate (,
:rection in response to erotic psychic stimuli. Ejaculation is a two-part
spinal reflex involves emission, the movement of the semen into the
-rrethra; and ejaculation proper, the propulsion of the semen out of the
rrethra at the time of orgasm. The touch receptors in the glans penis
:hat reach the spinal cord through the internal pudendal nerves, are
lifferent pathways which are mostly fibres.
Enumission is a sympathetic response, integrated in the upper lumbar
segments of the spinal cord and effected by contraction of the smooth
ruscle of the vasa differential and seminal vesicles in response to stimuli
:r the hypogastric nerves. Contraction of the bulb cavernous muscle, a
ud
.<eletal muscle results in the propulsion of semen from the urethra. The
.rinal reflex centres for this part of the reflex are in the upper saral
..rd lowest lumbar segments of the spinal cord, and the motor pathways
':averse the first to third seral roots and the internal pudendal
-:rves.
The semen which is ejaculated at tire time of orgasm contains sperms
..:d secretions of the seminal vesicles, prostate lowper's glands, and the
-.ethral glands. An average volume for ejaculate is 2.5-3.5 ml after
St
l
OCC'
periodic vaginal bleeding, the most conspicuous feature of the menstrual lron
ria
cycle, o""ri" with the shedding of the uterine mucosa (menstruation).
The average figure of the length of the cycle is 28 days from the start Whr
of one menstrual period to the start of the next, but it varies notoriously' wall
The days of the cycle are identihed by number, starting with the first day glan
of menstruation. to st
Uterine tube Ligament of the ovary Ovarian artery Ovary Uterine tube
sexu
, the I
\y;i', \..,, .,/' F'nd's Bectum Uterus
built
ate
/
autot
and ;
:rans
.---- lot d
Ovary Uterine cavity In
,han5
-'i'ome
Broad ligament
Cervix l
z' Urethra =Id a
Vagina uttoc
_
yM
,]
=rd rr
I
Fig. 13.4' The female reproductive system --at-to;
I
-iiL::lefe.
i:-: OVt
.ctior
:he r
it that is needed for final maturation, is selected to be the domtn ETIn I
flollicle. Many follicles develop simultaneously when women are g1\'(
ud
::rCOt
hiehly purified human pituitary gonadotropin preparations by injectio - 100
Distended follicle raptures at the 14th day of the cycle, and the ovum .--rcid,
extruded into the abdominal cavity. This process is called evolutic iusi
Fimbriated ends of the uterine tubes picks up the ovum, and -:lin
transported to the uterus. And unless fertilization occurs, it passes : '.-iral
through the vagina. :..-:des
The corpus luteum persists and periods doesn't occur, if prel -ctio
St
l
from the last menstrual period.
than 2g days
ria
The blood loss flow is arso variable from scanty to reratively
profuse.
when a woman is sexually excited, fluid is onto the vaginal
"""r"t"d
walls due to release of vasoactive intesti,al polypeptiae
vestibular
glards secrete lubricating mucus. The upper part oithe 1vre1.
vagina is sensitive
to stretch. Tactile stimulation from labia minora and ditiis
adds to the
sexual excitement- These stimuli are reinforced by tactile
stimuri from
the breasts and, as in men, by auditory and visual stimuli,
which may
:uilt up to erescendo known as orgasm. During orgasm, there
ate
are no
autonomically mediated rhythrnic contraction o1 the buluocavernosus
and ischiocavernosus muscres. The vaginal contraction
may aid sperm
:ransport but are not essential for it, since fertilization of
the ovum is
::ot dependent on orgasm.
In addition to enlargement of breasts, uterus, and vagina, the body
.:hanges
that develop in- girrs at puberty are due to feminining hormones.
''q'omen
have narrow shoulders and broad hips, thighs that converge,
:nd arms that diverge. The female distribution of fatln
the breasts and
:uttocks, is also seen in eastrate males and women have ress
body hair
i:rd more scalp hair, and the pubic hair generally has a
yM
characteristic
-at-topped pattern.
L3.2.3.2, Fertilization and Implantation
ud
'.spermy, the fertilization of the ovum by more than one sperm. This
--sient potential change is folrowed
by structurar change in the zona
:cida that provides protecting against polyspermy on"a more long-
:. basis.
3lastocyst the developing embryo moves down the tube
into the
-rs, in about 3 days, during which blastocyst reaches the 1g
or
:ll stage.
Page No. Thg226 blastocyst
of 328. becomes surrounded by an outer layer of
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
C
wall of the uterus is the implantation sit. A placenta then develops, and Str
ria
the tropoblast remains associated with it' in
The fetus and,the mother are two genetically distinct individuals' its
The fetus is in effect a transplant of foreign tissue in the mother. However'
the transplant is toleraled, and. the rejection reaction that is 13
characteristically produced when other foreign tissues are transplantei
fails to occur. em
abs
potr
ate
excl
lt stin
U incl
'.1'er(
\
l
AS S]
sttm
Egg cytoplasm
'he1
Egg cell membrane .his
yM
1'aVe
.-,e:-:ctir
Emission of Radiation". The laser beam has spatial and temp: m - rrpl
coherence and is monochromatic. The beam is highly directiona'l ; r las
exhibits high density energr which can be timely focussed' -:ted
The use of lasers in the medical field is suitable where the:: _ratt
favourable interaction between the laser radiation and the human tiss- .:n t
The merlical use of laser is dependent on radiation wavelength ner
ability of the tissue to absorb this wavelength, delivered po\rel shur
treatment area, total eners/ incident on tissue and the area trea
St
:_ las
Lasers have been especially successfi.rl in the following areas of
mej
.f 1ng
treatment:
(i) Treatment of detached retina. J3. I
(iz') Coagulation of eye in dielectric retinopatthy' : rr,-ef
(iii) Treatment of tissues in the skull and spine (neuro-surgen- -.-ndi
(iu)Treatmentbycoagulationofthelowergastrointestinaltrac:
Page No. 227 of 328. r ltV
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
spread
stic The most wide
medical application of laser technologz in medicine
ria
in opthalmologr. This is due to the easy accessibility has occurred
of the human eye,
its transparency and the absorptio r properties of its
internal tissues.
13.3.2. Principle of Operation of Laser
The laser action depends upon the
emission. In the normal state most atoms
absorption is generally for more likely
population inversion could be obtained (
ate
oton of the correct frequency could trigger
an avalanche of coherent photons. The
to grow so long as the scattering processes
inversion could be maintained.
For generation of raser beam, it is necessary
to have arr active medium
as shown in figure 13'6 in which atoms
are kept in an excited state and
stimulated by an outsid.e photon to emit right
in a particular direction.
rhe process by means of which a medium is
activated is ca,ed pumping.
lhis inflates enta,s- erectromagnetic energy into the medium
at a
yM
;avelength different from the stimulating wavelength.
l Total
l refractive
I mtrror
Resonator
Fig. 13.6. Main element of laser
The active medium is usuary enclosed in a resonator box with highly
ud
l
are as
The types of lesser usually employed in the medical field he
ria
follows: StI
13.3.3.1. Pulsed RubY Laser SCi
or pulses because
The ruby laser is usually operated in a short bursts
in upsetting
in continuor. *.rr" operation it gets heated up and resultsphysical damage
wa
cause
the distribution of atoms quantum states. This may cor
to the crystal. of,
can
13.3.3.2. Nd Yag Laser con
ate
NdYagLaseraSVeryusefulinmedicalfectionoloSz,alightguideisat prer
.,...."".ry-*hich transmits the laser energr rk The
the same time, is sufficiently flexible to per savl
in various helds like endoscopy, uroloS' neu
g.'
,a.:
dermatologr, dental surgery and general surgery'
13.3.3.3' Helium Neon Laser lhe
AHe_Nelasercanbeused.forthemeasurementofvisualactivityanc -93
is very helPful to the oPhthalmolog \eC
,) perfoiming cataract surgery on the T
yM
i ifris appti-ation is in the range of tntr
can also be used as a scannlng o -:mO
and its supporting structure inclu = r:CtII
underlying layers. This layer beam c
in case of correction of eye cracks developed in the retina'
I
_:on
13.3.3.4. Argon Laser :3.3.1
Thislaserisnotusedformedicalapplicationasthecathodeemiss::m
is severe at high currents. It limits iire life which must be
replac*di Th
' . etit
_ NIF
. : -eS,
St
.Di
with operating microscope' _Di
Argon ion photo-coagulator is m9re. suitable
"t Pn*:.:?1i1iil-l
theretinasincetheoutp"utformtheRubylaserisnoteffectivelyabsc:
! 1. I
l
healing process promptry. post operative odema is minimal in laser
ria
surgery. The healing is faster with minimum of tissue swelling and
scarring and with less post operative pain and discomfort.
The co, laser is high power continuously operating raser and its
wavelength is in the infrared region of 10.5 mm. This wavelength is
completely absorbed by most biological tissues. The most common use
of co, laser are in microsurgery. The coherent monochromatic beam
can be exactly focused on arr area approximately 1 mm diameter and is
controlled through the optical system connected to microscope. A very
ate
precise micro-manipulator directs the laser light to the treatment area.
The laser is now used in selected areas of larynx, pharynx and oral
cavity.
13.3.3.7. Excimer Laser
The excimer laser operate primarily in the urtraviolet spectral region.
L
lhe most common excimer lasers are argon-fluoride (ArF) operated at
i -93 mm, krypton-fluoride. (Kr F) operated at 24g mm, Xenon-chloride
Xecl) operated at 308 mm and Xenon-fluoride XeF operated at 351 mm.
:f
E The most important use of excimer laser is improving vision by
yM
1l rontrolled ablation of the cornea with A, F (193 mm) excimer laser and
tmoval of anthrochorositic plaque from arteries with Xecl (30g mm) /
::r 'rcimer laser one of the area of great clinical interest is laser angioplasty
e , to open authenosclerotic arteriar narrowings in peripheral
and
rronary artery.
:3.3.3.8. Semiconductor Laser
The semiconductor lasers are smafl in size and are highly efficient.
-1ey are mainly constrrrcted
using gallium arsenide/aluminium gallium
':senide indium phosphide/indium, gallium arsenide phosphide. Laser
--odes made of Al Gra As and can be convenientry used in photo
!d :agulation. These semriconductor lasers can be used for the treatment
ud
1. Diathermy in physriotherapy
l. Diathermy in surg;ery.
r 4.1. Diathermy in Physiotherapy
In the diathermy fi:r physiotherapy the siize of the electrodes are
':. as compared to cliathermy for surgical aLpplications.
Page No. 230 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
OD
early years used a spark-gap and induction coil giving pulses of 1 MHz ape
oscillation. Nowaday the diathermy machines uses much higher
ria
,S tV
frequencies. Since the wavelengths are much higher than the bod-t .: th
dimensions, the mechanism of heating is attributable to the movemen: : rdS
of ions in the tissue. The clinical objective of diathermy is to heat the _:twr
internal tissues without unduly raising the skin temperature and the ,ns i
heating depends upon the less angle of the tissues and the heat removed :^sto
by body circulations. If a greater localized heating of the subcrrtaneous
Ir
fatty layer is needed, microwave diathermy of 10 cm rvavelength is used lnn(
ate
The following type of diathermy equiprment for physiotherapy are ::OUI
used :
:t. v
1. Short-wave diathermy :ld i
2. Microwave diathermY _:ep
3. Ultrasonic therapy unit. -:atir
, :na
13.4.2. Short Wave Diathermy ..:thc
In diathermy for physiotherapy the patient body become a part of tht
electrical circuit and the heat is produced within the bod5r and tralsferenct
through the skin. It does not produce discomfort to the body as in cas:
yM
of externally applied source of hr:at like not towels, infrared lamps anc
electric heating pads.
Power
source
l
capacitor method as shown in figure 13.s (a) where the metal part act
ria
as two electrodes and body tissues to be treated by heat act as dielectric
of the capacitor. when the reduce frequency output is applied to the
pads, the dielectric loses of the capacitor produce heat in the tissues
cetween the electrodes. The dielectric losses may be due to vibration of
:ons and rotation of diodes in the tissue fluids (electrolytes) and molecular
listortion in tissues.
In another method the output of the diathermy machine may be
:onnected to a flexible cable in stead of pADS. This cable is coiled
ate
around the effected portion in this case the arm as shown in figure 13.g
e). when RF current is passed through such a cable, an electrostatic
:leld is set up between its ends and a magnetic field around the centre.
)eep heating in the tissues result from electrostatic action whereas the
,:eating of the superficial tissues is obtained by eddy currents set up by
- magnetic effect. The technique is known as inductothermy linducuvl
rethod).
Electrode
yM
I
I
I I
I I
I I
I I tttttt
I I ltttrl
I I tttttL ttt! I I
I ttlttz I tltt I I I I I ll
I I I t t, It I I tttt I I I I I ll
I I I ltll I I I ll
I tttt I ll
Layer of towel
between electrode Electrode
and skin Joints to be
treated
ud
l
13.4.3. Microwave DiathermY
ria
The microwave range for diathermy purpose is between 3OO-3O,OO0
MHz in frequency and wavelength varying from 10 mm to 1 m' The most
commonly used microwave frequency for heating is 2450 MHz. Microwave
diathermy provides one of the most valuable sources of therapeutic heat
available to physician. In some of the cases the results of microwave
diathermy are same as of short wave diathermy but in some cases the
results of microwave diathermy are better. The technique of application
of microwave diathermy is very simple. In microwave diathermy no PADS
ate
are required as in case of short wave diathermy. In microwave diatherml-
the microwaves are transmitted. from an emitter and are directed towards
the portion of the body to be treated the waves pass through the
intervening one space and one absorbed by the surface of the bodl-
producing the heating effect.
A special type of device called magnetron is used for the production fixt
of higtr frequency current of high power. The output enerSr is derived
from the resonant or system by means of a coupling loop. The energ; 13.4
packed up by the coupling loop is carried out of the magnet|on in the
tentral conduction of a coaxial output tube through a glass seal to a -.)
yM
-
director. The director consists of a relaviting element of antenna and a ::gul
reflector which direct the enerSr for application to the patient' ::S ST
:-eCt
13.4.4. Ultrasonic TheraPY Unit
In ultrasonic therapy unit the heating is produced due to th:
absorption of ultrasonic enerSr by the tissues. The effect of ultrasor::
ener$/ into tissue is high speed mechanical vibration which is nothi::5
but micro massage of soft tissues. As all of us know the massage is useC
to treat tissues the same principle is employed in ultrasonic therapl
The electrical power required in most of the applications is usually less
than 3 W lcrnd of the transducer are that is in contact with the pan d
ud
These mechanical vibration then pass through a metal cap and into -n
holes tissues though a coupling medium. The therapeutic ultrasc. . ---n(
St
The heart of the system is a tuned oscillator which produces the electrical
oscillation of the required frequency.
The oscillator output is given to the power amplifier which drives the
liezoelectric crystal to generate ultrasonic waves.
l
ria
ate
Ultrasonic Transducer
Active
Electrode
RF
Generator Body
Passive
Electrode
ud
l
ria
Fig. 13.11. Block diagram of solid state diathermy machine
The RF generator provides high frequency carrier signal which is 13.
modulated by a tone generator giving waveforms for coagulation and
cutting. The RF power is turned onloff with a control circuit connected
to switch which is operated by surgeon. The output circuit couples the :nt
ate
modulated RF output to active electrode. ,4.:
tlsin
yM
I
Blood, urine, cerebrospinal fluid and other fluids are analysed in the :t th
chemistry section to find the content of various clinically important
substances. 13.5
The determination of numbers and characteristics of the formed V
elements in the blood i.e.,red blood cells, white blood cells, and platelets: - ave,
atrd aiso functions of physiological systems in the blood i.e., blood clotting. ave
etc. are done in the hematologr section. The microbiologz section helps : ISOI
in studies on various body tissues and fluids to determine whether :3.5.
pathological microorganisrns are existing.
In a1l above electronic automation arc quite common. Mainframes A
:I]SS
and minicomputers keep track of salient parameters. The fast response.
ihe accuracy and precision are essential requirements. an
ud
It
13.5.1. Spectrophotometry
'3.5.2
It is based on the fact that substances of clinical interest selectiveh-
absorb or emit electromagnetic enerry at different wavelengths i.e.. It
ultraviolet (200 to 400 nm), r,isible (400-700 nm) or near the infrarec -:lts.
(700 to 800 nm). Most of the instruments operate in the visible range. -:h
'-r-le
Figure 13.12 shows the block diagram of a spectrophotometer. It includes
'i -ch
St
,*M : _-I1e f
Injr
Car
l
Wavelength selector = Glass filter and interference filters and
ria
monochromators using prisms and diffraction
gratings.
Cuvette = Holds the substance being antalyzed.
Detector = Photometric system.
13.5. 1.1. Flame Photometers
In this, case the power source and the sample holder are combined
:n the flame. It can determine only the concentrations of pure metals.
ate
13.5. 1.2. Atomic Emission
The flame photometer, produce about loh of the atoms are raised to
:xcited stage. Only a few elements produce enough power at single
,i-avelength when they move from higher ener$/ orbit to lower-energr
-,rbit. In view of this, its growth has been for only limited usage.
The sample combined with a solvent is drawn into the flame. Propane
-,r natural gas is mixed with compressed air. The solvent evaporates in
:re flame, Microscopic particles of the sample are left. These particles
:isintegrate giving atoms in very small proportion. When the atoms fall
yM
:r the ground state, it release power at their characteristic wavelength.
f 3.5.1.3. Atomic Absorption
Vast majority of atoms in flame absorb ener5/ at characteristic
-,r-avelength. A special power source is used
to emit power at characteristic
:r-aveiength. A photomultiplier is used as detector. The amount of
ibsorption is proportional to the amount of the atom present.
13.5.1.4. Fluorometry
A number of molecules emit light in a characteristic spectrum the
.nission spectrum-soon after absorbing radiant eners/ and being raised
:r an exited state.
ud
l
CO
ria
elt
I
13
bl(
col
13
ate
Fig. 13.13. Gas-liquid chromatograph (GLC) block diagram IrIL
dn
A sample GLC recording is shown in figure 13.74.
13.
sta
GS
Detector
output nel
yM
cur
t, mei
als<
Time
13J
Fig. 13.14. GLC record of analysis of blood
\t
13.5.3. Electrophoresis rehi
It means proteins in plasma and urine etc., to identity antiboides,
Electrophoresis is the movement of a solid phase with respect to a liquic :epl
i.e., buffer solution. ^lvir.
Magnitude of charge: The mobility of particle is directly related tc
ud
density ::om
I
:oml
lhe r
:Sa
Migration distance
rth
Fig. 13.15. Pattern of serum protein electrophoresis
Page No. 237 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
concentration of particles.
Time: The distance of migration is directly related to the time of
ria
electrophoresis.
13.5.4. Hematology
These are devices which measure characteristics formed element-red
blood cells, white blood cells and platelets. Electronic devices are quite
common.
13.5.5. Kymogrpah
ate
Kymograph is an instrument for continuous recording of heart beats,
muscle contraction and respiratory, events. It is comprised of a metal
drum, rotating spinals, electric motor, etc.
13.5.6. Galvanic Skin Resistance (GSR)
It is the change in skin resistance due to sweating. The emotional
state such as fear, panic or alertness indication can be achieved through
GSR. An active electrode is fixed on the palm of the hand and a second
neutral electrode is placed on the wrist or back of the hand. Constant
current of about 10 mA is passed through the electrodes and GSR is
yM
measured. GSR is in the range of 10 to 500 kw. GSR measurement is
also used in lie detection test.
l
approaches to functionalizator, of biomaterials exist. plasma processing
has been successfuily applied to chemically inert materials like polymerJ
ria
or silicon to graft various function groups to the surface of the implant
inside living system materials for biological use are classified according
to their base stnrcture as ceramics composites, metals and players.
These are per Table 13.3.
13
Table 13.3. Classification and Biomaterials
TT
S.No. Classification Material example Application ]Ir.
ate
1 Ceramics Aluminium oxide Dental and orthopaedic Th
2 Composites Carbon-carbon hbres Heart valves and joint Th
implants. pa
c Metals Aluminium, gold Joint replacements, an
titanium, iron. pacemaker sti
and electrodes nel
4 Polymers Nylon, synthetic rubber Replacement of soft ani
tissues like skin, blood extr
vessels, cartilage.
yM
Synthetic polymers constitute the vast majority of biomaterials usei
in humans. A polymer is characterized, by repeating submit (rnonomer
covalently connected to form a macro_molecule.
Synthetic polymers are made by two processes:
(f Addition polyrnerrzation e. g., poryethylen e, polymethyr methacryrate.
poly vinyl chloride and polyethylene_terephtalai.
(ii) Condensation polymerization e.g., polyesters, polyamicles anc
pol5rurethanes. 13.7
The detailed, most commonly used porymers and their applicatior-
are: :he
(i) Polyethylene: Low density - Bags, tubing Jaln
ud
l
surrounding tissues and the body as a whole.
ria
(ii) Bulk and surface properties of polymer biomaterial which are
functiom of their molecular structure and organisation, determine
their interaction with living organisms.
STIMULATORS
The various type of stimulators are used for pain relief. The electrical
impulses are used to block the pathways of the transmission of pain.
ate
The electrical impulses are produced in a battery powered pulse generator.
The pulses are passed on to the effected portion of the body through a
pair of electrodes. The electrical impulses are applied to the skin overlying
any painful area of the body. The electrodes provide mild electrical
stimulation. These signals abstract the pain signals travelling along the
nerye pathways before they can reach the brain. The result is like taking
analgesic, often for hours after stimulation ends. The pain control is
explained by the following methods:
1. The gate control theory which suggest that by electrically stimulating
sensory nerve receptors, a gate mechanism is closed in a segment
yM
of the spinal cord, preventing pain carrying messages from reaching
the brain and blocking the perception of pain.
2. The endorspin release theory suggests that electrical impulses
stimulate the production of endorspin and enkaphalins in the brain,
in a similar fashion to conventional drug therapy, but without the
danger of dependance on drug or any other side effects.
13.7.1. Transcutaneous Electrical Nerve Stimulator (TENS)
TENS provide electrical impulses required for electrotherapy to tract
the pain. The sqr:are wave or spike wave are equally effective relieving
pain. In most of the stimulators the adjustable settings are provided for
ud
l
electrodes
are made thin to achieve conformability. Useful carbon_loaded silicon
rubbers have a minimum resistivity of 1O e cm.
ria
13.7.2. Muscle Stimulators
These stimulators are used for physicar therapy for exercising the
muscle to regain function of pararyzed muscles, to gain ability to grasp
in case of paralytic hand, gaining control of rowei extremities i.2., to
stand, walk. The different types of currents are used for different
applications.
ate
(a) Galvanic Current
A steady flow of direct current (dc) is passed through the skin (tissue)
producing a chemical effect used in treatment of paralysis and disturbance
of blood flow.
(b) Faradic Current
A sequence of triangurar pulses with pulse duration of about 1 ms
to 20 ms is used for treatment of muscle weakness. (
l
ria
Monostable Higher
multi-vibrator tmp.
(Pulse width) Const Current
source
The receiver demodulates the signal and pass them into the
:ropriate muscles to produce stimulation.
The receiver and transmitter are shown in figure 1&12. The
receiver
- -rit is embedded in an epoxy disc coated with siticon
rubber for,tissue
n':-patibility.
wic
ger
l
131
ria
1.
ate
s
T
lmplantable Transrnitting lv
antenna antenna
(b)
t
(a)
r
Fig. 13.17. (a) lmplantable radio receiver with leads, p
(b) External transmitting unit with an antenna T
The receiver with three leads of platinum-iridium are placed ove: St
ofspinalmusclesduringSurgery.Thereceiverisplacec h
ous pocket on the converse side of the curve' Tht
yM
F,
ennaisaflatdiscwhichistapedontheskinoverth: c'<
e
The cerebellar stimulation is useful in the treatment of epilepsr : )1I
Stimulation to cerebellum is provided by transcutaneous induc--: -:ac
coupling through an antenna fixed subcutaneously on the chest. I: Diar
deliverJ through from pairs of platinum discs fixed on a plate of sil:l :ry
coated mesh. The electrode bearing plate is placed on both the ante: : f1t
and posterior cerebellar cortex. Normally the rectangular pulses of I --:e(
Page No. 243 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
1 The body temperature is determined by the delicate balance between
heat production and heat loss. The traditional noimal value for the
oral temperature is 37'c (98.6"F). chronic elevation of 0.5"c occurs
when the metabolic rate is high and lowered when metabolic rate is
low. Few normal adults chemically have a temperature above the
normal range. The reflex and semi-reflex thermoregulatory responses
in humans are mechanisms activated by hot and cold. The mechanism
activated by cold which increase heat production, are hunger,
ate
shivering, increased voluntary activity, increased secretion of
morepinephrine and curling up, horropilation and cutaneous
vasoconstriction decrease the heat. The mechanism's activated by
heat such as increased heart loss due to sweating, increased
respiration and cutaneous vasodilation; and also decreased heat
production due to anorexia, apathy and inertia.
The hypothalamus integrates body temperature information from
I sensory receptors in the skin, deep tissues of spinal cord, extra
I hyperthermic portions of the brain, and hypothalamus itself.
I Fever is most universally known hall mark of disease. Body temperate
yM
r can be measured by the mercury thermometer, but recording is not
feasible. In view of this, electronic thermometers are available based
on the principle of the thermocouple and the thermistor. Skin
temperature measurement is done using flat thermistor probe
thermometer or infrared radiation thermometer.
The multiple differences between males and females depend primarity
on a single chromosome, i.e. Y-chromosome and single pair of
endocrine structures, the testes in the male and the ovaries in the
female. Male cells contain an X and y chromosorne, i.e. Xy pattern.
The female cells contain two X chromosomes, i.e. Xy pattern.
The semen ejaculated by male at the time of orgasm contains sperms
ud
given to the joint or their tissues without lecting the skin, unlike
the
application of heat by hot pads and towels, etc'
The following main types of diathermy equipments are ln use:
l
(i) Short wave diathermY
ria
(ii) Microwave diathermY
('
(iii) Ultrasonic theraPY unit' (t,
Intheshortwavediathermyunitthetissuebecomesthepartofthe
circuit while in microwave diathermy and ultrasonic therapy unit'
1C
IJ.
1a
thetissuetobeheated'areappliedmicrowaveorultrasonicenergi- 1J.
1C
through aPPlication. 1J-
precisell-
In surgery the diathermy unit is used to cut the tissues very
blood in case
as well as for coagulation purpose' There is no loss of
13..
ate
]? I
of surgery by way of surgical diathermy'
department
5. The clinical laboratory is also known as clinical pathologr of the
13. (
l
the patient.
ria
txercidea
3. 1.Write short notes or-r bocly temperature.
l-
o.z. Write short notes on reproduction system.
)) Describe micro'qzave diathermy machine. Discuss
electro-diagnostic
therapeutic apparatus.
3.4. Erplain the working of a modern surgical diatherrn}. machine.
ate
35 trxplain the use of diathermy in physiotherapy and surgery.
3.6. Explain diathermy and defibrillator. Also explain defibrillator analyzers.
(UPTU 2006)
7. Write short notes on diathermy. ppTU 2OC:S)
8. trxplain the application of laser in medicine. (U7TU 2OO4)
9. Discuss with a block diagram the working of a laser system.
10. Discuss laser inieraction with tissue.
1 1. Differentiate between use of laser in surgery and coagulation.
AJJ
ud
St
l
ria
Monitors and Recorders
H gh freq
filter
EI
St
Grouno -
Fig. 14.1. Bioelectric potential with differential amplifier
248
l
measured.
ria
1b) Amplifier should have high gain of the order of looo or more so
that weak biological signals of the order of mv or mv are amplified.
1c) These amplifiers should have high CMMR.
d) voltage appearing at the amplifier input due to changes in magnetic
fields should be minimised.
e) Amplifiers should have isolation ciruitry for the safety of the patient
being studied.
Earlier transistorized amplifrers were being used to amplify and operate
ate
-: writing device. Now at the input stage the operation amplihers (oA)
.sed on IC technolos/ are being used. The commonly used lC is 741.
- --:
IC contains 2o transistors and other passive components. The circuit
i :graJrr and pin diagram of this IC may be seen in the data books on
t.
.n the circuit:
R"=
TJOI
R.=R,=R-
m
+ e, is input to amplifier A,
m
+ e, is input to amplifier A,
Page No. 248 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
"- {,-'+}
"s= x @r- e1t M
I R,J sy
l
The input ampliliers A, and A, act as input buffers with unity gain th
ria
cir
e" with a gain of
I zn^l
for the differe- thr
for common mode signal and.
tt.T, I ar(
rec
ntial gain. These amplifiers work as biomedical amplifrer due to very of
high input impedance, high gain and good common mode rejection ratio'
mo
The isolation in bioelectric amplifies are provided by the incorporation
of an opto coupler. In the opto coupler there is an LED at the input stage
war
and a photo-transistors is provided at the output stage.
ate
the
Normally a transistorized circuit is provided at the output stage to dev
supply current to the pen coil of the galvanometer. The pen motor is disl
driven by a dc driven stage feeding a four transistor output stage operating Warv
the galvanometer. Due to low power efficiency of push pull amplifier a on,
bridge arrangement is preferred. A circuit diagram may be seen in
hgure 14.3.
mor
disp
(
bes
yM
14.2,
\
lare
:il0nl
T
ll :lr w
-lr a
imoo
.76
=rd h
ud
.: ter
anb
TT
_: ho
Fig. 14.3. Output stage using bridge amplifier for driving galvanometer coil in recorom : lwer
The current in I, and ?o increases and T, and T. decreases' Tl-- :ack r
when T, and ?o approximates to short circuits, ?, and Ta are nearly c :: pov
off and almost all the circuit current passes through the galvano In
St
coil. t and 71. function as emitter loads, I. and To operate as amplifica: - _trsln
having I, and ?. as collector loads. Resistors R, to Ro provide coc =:-t be
biasing to T, and To. - ton(
--splay
:-the
Page No. 249 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Monitors and Recorders 251
l
:ie display of waveforms in electronic laboratories. They have the usual
ircuit blocks like vertical and horizontal amplifiers the time base a,nd
ria
ne EHT (Extra High Tension) for the cathode ray tube. These monitors
,-re of slow speed and long persistence type of screen. The slow speed
. equire a long persistence screen so as to enable a conveniept observation
ate
hese purposes non fade monitors using digital memories have been
leveloped to overcome the problem of the fading of slow scanning CRT
lisplays. By using this technique it is possible to generate a rolling
'.r'aveform display. The display is thus continuous, bright and flicker free
ln a normal non-storage CRT.
This means that normal oscilloscopes are not suitable to work as
nonitors. A special type of digital storage scope with non-fade type of
lisplay may be a suitable choice.
Some of the details of non-fade displays and cardiac monitors may
je seen in the chapter on Patient care and Monitoring.
yM
14.2.'1. Video Monitors "t
Video monitors are used in intensive care unit and intensive cardiac
:are unit. Video monitors are provided as bed side monitors and video
lonitors for central monitoring.
The monitor (display) part has two subsections-raster type display
rcr waveforms and a conventional 300 x 260 picture-element but map
rcr aplphanumeric display and graphics. To make the waveforms look
smooth, a l2OO line vertical raster is used. The display section also uses
a 16 KB word memory, which is used as temporary storage for waveform
and hard copy data. ECG waveform for each patient is continually stored
ud
:rursing room a video and audio alarms are provided. The audio alarm
,-an be distinguished by varying its pitch, volume, duration and sequence
rf tones. Visual alarms can be indicated by varying the colour of the
lisplay on the monitor screen. The bed side monitor data can be monitored
rn the central nursing station.
The various types of display are now available like CRT display,
plasma display, liquid. crystal display (LCD), surface conduction electron
emitter display (sED).
l
ria
In any instrumentation system one of the important consideration is the
method by which the data acquired is recorded. The recording method
should be consistent with the typical system. If the signal is analogue
and the analogue output is available for recording then we need an
analogue recorder to record the event. On the other hand, if the system
has a digital output then digital recor:ding system to needed.
/Thus there are two types of recorders are used:
ate
(a) Analogue Recorders.
(b) Digital Recorders.
Analogue Recorders are of various types. They can be broadly classified
as under: PaI
(z) Graphic Recorders.
(irJ Osicllographic Recorders. elec
(ifiJ Magnetic Tape Recorders. ISL
The Graphic Recorders are devices which display and store a pen *.:
and ink record of some physical event. The basic element of a recorder
include a chart for displaying and storing the recorded information, a
yM
papr
chart drive for driving paper with known speed and a suitable coupling
for connecting the source of information. The graphic recorders can be Mar
further classified as follows:
(a) Strip Chart Recorders: :hat
A strip chart recorder records one or more variables with respect to lapll
-,r'hic
time. Normally it is X verses time (t) recorder.
(b) X-Y Recorders: 1orn
An X-Y recorder records one or more dependent variables with respect lsed
to an independent variable. :teth
ipee(
14.3.1. Strip Chart Recorder -he
ud
<
A basic strip chart recorder may be seen in figure 14.4. A strip charr :atcl
recorder consists of: -l op
(r') A long roll of graph paper which moves vertically. Mark
(irJ A drive system for driving the paper at some selected speed. -{ Sr
speed selector switch is provided for chart speeds of 1 mm/sec tc . his
lOO mm/sec. .:vius
(iirJ A stylus for making marks on the moving graph paper. The stylus ,iack
St
Stylus drive
system
Stylus
l
ria
Analogne
ntermation
'- be recorded
ate
Poper drive
mechanism
Fig. 14.4. Basic Strip Chart Recorder
. aper Drive System
- he paper drive system moves the paper at a uniform
speed. An
.:-onic stepper motor, synchronous motor or spring wound mechanism
..ed for driving the paper.
llirking Mechanism
- here are many types of mechanisms used for making marks on the
yM
r :r. The most commonly used ones are as follows:
f,arking with Ink filled Stylus
ud
stylus marking in this method the paper with special coating which is
sensitive to a current. When the current is passed from the stylus to the
paper a trace appears on the paper. In electrostatic stylus method the
stylus produces a high voltage discharge which produces a permanent
l
trace on an electro-sensitive paper. The other method is optical marking
method. This method uses a beam of light to write on a photosensitive
ria
paper. This method allows higher frequencies to be recorded and permits
a relatively large chart speed with a good resolution. The disadvantage
is the cost of paper which is very high and this is a photographic method
and in this case the paper must be developed before a record is available.
This method is not very suitable, where instantaneous monitoring is
required.
Tracing Systems
ate
There are two types of tracing systems used for producing graphic
representations. In the curvilinear system the stylus is mounted on a
central pivot and moves through an arc. In this system the time base
is curved. lines. The other system is rectiiinear system of tracing. In the
system a line of constant time is perpendicular tc the time axis and
therefore the system produces a straight line across the width of the
chart.
In the biomedical recorders the electrode picks up the bioelectrica-
potentials and transducer is used to convert the physiological signal to
be measured into a usable electrical output. The signal conditione:
yM
converts the output of the electrode/transducer into an electrical quantiq'
suitable for operating the writing system. The writing system provides a
visible graphic representation of the input signal.
14.3.2. Galvanometric Recorders
The mechanism of Galvanometric recorder is a modifred form c:
DArsonval meter movement. A cut-away view of the moving coil elemer-:
is shown in figure 14.5. As the current flows through the coil it deflec:=
The deflection of the coil is proportional to the input quantity. Th"t
instrument requires an appreciable torque. For this a large moving cc:l
in a stroilg magnetic field is needed. The instrumcnt lnust be criticaf
damped so there is no overshoot. But this results in slow respons:-
ud
which is being of the order of 0.75 to 1.5 sec. This type of recorder 5
not r-rseful for recording fast variations in either current or voltage. T1--:r
is suitable for recording average values.
A galvanometer type recorder is shown in figure 14.6.It is a modited
version of PMMC (Permanent Magnet Moving Coil) instrument. the ch
may be driven at a constant speed by a clock',riork movement, an electr-
motor or stepper motor. The recorder shown in fig. 14'6 uses a rectil
St
l
Steel ring
ria
Moving coil
ate
Spirols
Steel core
lnk reservoir
Moving coil
movement
yM
Rollers
Drive-motor
Curvi-linear chort
Rollers
?aper.
The usual paper drive is by a synchronous motor with a gear box for
;chieving different chart speeds. The other method of achieving variable
=peed by the use of different crystal frequency is also employed.
Normally
= time.marker is produced before taking the ECG or other recording.
As already studied by the students in the course on measurement
254 ofthe
=:rd Instruments
Page No. 328.PMMC instrument using galvanometric principle
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
has three forces which act upon the moving system namely (4 the d
deflecting force (ir) the controlling force and (lir) the damping force. The p
deflection force results from the current which flows in the coil and is a)
supplied to it from the driving ampliher. This force cause the pen to hi
l
move from its zero position. A controlling force applied by the spring et
ria
action will limit the otherwise indefinite movement of the pen and ensure w.
that same movement of pen is always achieve by a given value quantity 1n
to be recorded. The damping force is necessary in order to bring the wl
position of pen to rest quickly. In the absence of damping, owing to the mi
inertia of the moving parts, the pen would oscillate about the final ap
deflecting position for some time before coming to rest. The main function ap
of damping is to absorb energz from the oscillating system and to bring an
it quickly in its equilibrium position. The amount of overshoot of pen sh
ate
depends upon the value of the damping factor. This is taken as unity no
when the galvanometer is critically damped. Under these conditions, the
coil r'rill deflect smoothly and take up its final position in the shortest
possible time.
T Potentiometric Recorders
Potentiometric recorders are used for recording of low frequencv
phenomena. The basic disadvantage of a galvanometer type of recorder
is that it has a low input impedance and a limited sensitivity. The
operating principle of a potentiometer recorder is shown in figare 14.7
A resistive slide wire AB is supplied with a constant current from a
yM
Li
voll
battery S. The slide wire is constructed trom a resistance wire of high F
stability and uniform cross section so that resistance per unit length is
constant. The unknown dc voltage is fed between the moving contact C
and one end A of the slide wire. The moving contact C is adjusted so tha:
the current flowing through the detector is zero. At that moment the
unknown input voltage is proportional to the length of the wire AC. k-
practice the slide wire is calibrated in terms of span voltage being 100.
10 or 1 mV. The moving contact of the slide wire is attached with a per:
which writes on a caliberated chart. ..:TIC
The balancing of the unknown input voltage with reference to the --:ne
reference voltage is achieved by using a servo motor. The voltage difference ..:lp
ud
between the sliding contact C and the input dc signal is given to a -mj
chopper type dc amplifier (in place of a galvanometer coil). The coppe: :tl
is driven at the mains frequency and convert this voltage difference intc I
a square wave signal. This signal is amplified by the amplifier and the:- ,':le
applied to the control winding of the servo motor. The servo moto: : -:aI
is a two phase motor whose second winding is supplied with a 50 H_- 'ra
mains supply which works as a reference phase winding. The motor -= -. iln
mechanically coupled to the sliding contact of the potentiometer wher= ::.S
St
l
each other. The out of phase alternative currents irr the two stator
ria
windings produce a rotating magnetic field. The rotating magnetic held
induces a voltage in the rotor and resulting current in the armature
which makes the rotor to rotate in the same direction as the rotating
magnetic fields. For producing a rotating magnetic-field the ac voltage
applied to one stator winding should be 9o' out of phase with the volta[e
applied to the other winding. This can be done either in the po*E,
amplifier, which supplies the voltage to control winding or in a prrr""
shift network for the line winding. For zero input signai the rotor does
ate
not turn.
o
.0)
o=
.Nj
aa
+a)
v)-
o
yM
o.
AC servometer
Fig. 14.7. Schematic diagram of a self-balancing potentiometric recorder
The paper chart is driven by a constant speed motor to provide a
:-re axis. In this type of recorder the input signal is plotted against
i :re. In the current generation of record.ers the chart is moved with the
F ,ip of a stepper motor. The advantage of using a stepper motor
in
ud
liability and
, has two hxed
-s and one coil on which the pen is htted. The distance is measured
St
1 Itraviolet Recorders
4.3.3. U re
The galvanometric and potentiometric recorders due to the inertia of el
writing system are not suitabte to work when the signal is of higher utr
frequency. Ultra-violet (UV) recorders record the events with frequencies pa
l
from zero to several kHz. The writing system of an ultra-violet recorder 25
ria
consists of an ultra-violet light source and a photosensitive paper. The dis
trace becomes variable in 30 sec after the exposure. If the recordings are res
required for permanent storage then after the exposure paper should be of,
chemically treated.
The recorder consists of a number of galvanometer (moving coil) anc
elements mounted in a single magnet block as shown in figure 14.8. A wirr
surface silvered mirror is attached to the galvanometer coil. A paper barr
sensitive to r.ltraviolet light is used for producing a trace for the purpose volt
ate
of recording. The ultra-violet light is projected on the paper with the help app
JOSl
or mirror's attached to the galvanometer coil.
char
UV :rak
light
source
:oatr
::om
Poper drive mechanism T
:i dr
.25
-:ree
yM
UV light
-sed.
Sensitive paper :'a lel
Recorded trace + -:ctrr
._-cxll'l
Timing line Galvanomes
coils i : turi
.ir_ lUfi
Fig. 14.8. Ultraviolet (u.v.) recorder
]:fUe
The moving (galvanometer) coil is deflected if any current is passed
i4.3.5.
through its coil, because the coils are under the influence of magnetrc
freld. The ultra violet light falling on it is deflected and is projected co Tht
the u.v. light sensitive paper through a lens and mirror system. ::em
paper is clriven past the moving light spot and thus a trace of variau
ud
record o
electro ;i
upto s T
paper for recording and gives
l
250 mm per sec. The electro
ria
iisadvantage of stylus inertia, effects such as
overshoot or low-frequency
'esponse limits, rinkage effects such as non-rinearity,
:,f clogging of ink, etc.
hysteresis effects
The electrostatic recording co
,nd vacuum knife. The imaging
,,'ire elements, spaced
4 per mm.
ars called shoes. As the paper mo
rltage is applied to the selected
ate
:plied to the closest shoes. The pape
,sitively charged ink particles aaheie to where
the paper had a
'arge' A vacuum knife removes arl excess toner and
other
--king the image with charged particles. when erposed to
air the
ated particles permanentry
- in the machine completely bond dry.
to the paper and the record emerges
The paper is moved at a speed of 0.25
cord is made
dots. At the top speed of 2SO mm/
_ r mm. In defining frequency
t spacing of
- :e response atic recorder
capture, bandwidth and waveform response are
yM
, .d. defined as the shortest ar.atio"
- :ep frlse which can
value of recorder. The peak capture rating of the
' ':rostatic recorder is 40 microsecond. ganawiatn
': ''imum sine wave frequency which can be recordedis defined as the
with a specified
' 'racy. The bandwidth of the recording system is sooo Hz with an
' ''racy of 2ok or 15 kHz with an accuracy of 2ook No waveform
'' .,-ency analysis will be possible. or
light beam
"lt'"Jll,'l
l} ",k:
u p to t o o o Hz. rh e arra.g.-" r,":"::H
: between the poles of an electromagnet. Theh"r,ff
:i :.,-::i"
- - nagnet coils of this
to the output amplifrer and are driven by
piified cylindricai permanent magnet is attached
St
The filtered ink is frlled in the reservoir. The high pressure for jet InIr
recording in produced by a pump and is adjustable between 20-50
atmospheric pressure. The inkjet recorders are suitable for recording at mal
high frequency due to the absence of any moving assembly. The mass
l
in this case is comparable to that of UV recorder. In this case the Prir
amplitude of 60 mm peak to peak can be traced with the inkjet recorder'
ria
It different colour ink is used then the inkjet recorder can work as :art
multichannel recorder. Since, the inkjet recorder can write on the trr1n
recording paper without friction, linear tracing is ensured even with ven- _1av(
small amplitudes. The inkjet recorder use the normal untreated paper rr fe
which is much cheaper as compared to heat sensitive, photographic
paper. This type of recorder is suitable for phonocardiography and :t1Ovr
ate
as compared to Pen tYPe recorder. ::1e tr
leCOr
14.3.6. Colour Printer -.estr
Inkjet printers were introduce in the market in 1980. An inkje:
printer places extremely small droplets of ink onto paper to create or-
i*u.g.. The dots are extremely small usually between 50 and 60 microns
in diameter. The dots are thinner than the diameter of human ha-::
(70 microns). The dots are positioned on the paper very precisely, wir-
resolution of upto I44O x 720 dots per inch (dpi).
There are several major printer technologies available. Thest
yM
technologies can be broken down into two main categories with severa
types in each.
A. Impact
These printers have a mechanism that touches the paper in order ::
create an image. There are two main technologies-
. Dot matrix printers use a series of small pins to strike a ribbc-
coated with ink, causing the ink to transfer to the paper at Lt
point of impact. Thr
. Character printers are basically computerised t5rpewriters' Thgt :-:thor
have a ball or series of bars with actual characters (letters cr - -: III
numbers) embossed on the surface. The appropriate character s :
ud
:his
struck against the ink ribbon, transferring the character's image :n' : -:ble
the paper. ::ott
':'---s n
B. Non-Impact - crir
These printers do not touch the paper when creating an image, inl'-ra clet
printers are part of this group and includes. {p
. Inkjet printers which use a series of nozzles to spray drops of : IIO
directly on the PaPer.
St
r Crj
. Laser printers use dry ink (toner), static electricity and hea: -:n tl
place and bond the ink onto the paper. : 1OZ2
-:pla
Print Head AssemblY
Print head is the core of an inkjet printer. The print head cont
a series of nozzles that are used to spray drops of ink.
Page No. 259 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Ink Cartridge
In colour printer the cartridge has three primary colours cyan,
=agenta, yellow and black (CMYK).
l
Print Head Stepper Motor
ria
A stepper motor moves the print head assembly (print head and ink
,rartridges) back and forth across the paper. A belt is used to attach the
of the inkjet printers
paper in from the tray
ead assembly is ready
ate
:e printers to control all the mechanical aspect of operation, as well as
tcode the information sent to the printer from the microprocessor based
.strument.
Heating
\
\1+
lnk
reservors
yM
cble. As the bubble expands, some of the ink is pushed out of a nozzle
:o the paper. when the bubble collapses, a vacuum is created. This
-ls more ink into the print head from the cartridge. A typical bubble
print head has 300 on 600 tiny nozzres and all of then can fire a
, plet simultaneously.
:-en the crystal vibrates inward, it forces a tiny amount of ink out of
nozzle. when it vibrates out, it pulls some more ink into the reservoir
:eplace the ink sprayed out.
l
C
(;A
ria
ate
Nozzle
14.4, I SUMMARY
1. Biopotential Amplifier: The preamplifier and power amplifier is
to drive the pen motors of the recorder.
2. Monitor: The monitor is a display devices to display the im
physiological parameters such as ECG, heart rate, etc' There
u"iior" types of CRT"s such as non fade, bouncing ball etc', u-
St
l
OE elcided
ria
1. Discuss requirement of an ideal biopotential amplifrer.
2. With a block diagram discuss the various stages in an operational
ampliher OA.
3. Explain any two types of recorders with the help of suitable diagrams.
(UPTU 2OOs)
1.4. Explain ultra-violet (UV) recorders. (UPTU 2006)
-1.5. Discuss inkjet and potentiometric recorders. (UPTU 2006)
-.6. Explain monitors and printers.
ate
(UPTU 2006)
:.7. Discuss different types of displays in a monitor.
JAA
\
r ,1t
t;
yM
7
ud
St
l
ria
Shock Hazards and Prevention
ate
r5.1. Physiological Effects of Electrical Current
t5.2. Shock Hazards from Electrical Equipment
15.3. Methods of Accident Prevention
t5.4. Isolated Power Distribution Si,'stem
\
Kno\
yM
15.5. Summary :o tt
:lSSL
:he 1
Awareness for safety from shock hazards from medical equipmen:-" :ISSU
is of prime importance. During seventies sensational reports we- .lmit,
published on microshock hazards which was the cause of large numb'r .s hi1
of deaths of patients in intensive-care units. Consequently numero--:s :he d
regulations and standards came into existence to improve electrical safe-- :arts
in the hospital. Although some of the requirements have increased ''= :r Fil
cost of health care, but this development has dehnitely contributed ln
improved design of electrical and electronic equipments in medical use
ud
Two contacts must exist with the bodv and simultaneously voi: - ,h{
source to drive current through the two contacts should also exist. :, -en$
damaging effects of the current depend on the magnitude and alsc ,,.::Sat
the current path way through the body, which in turn depends or: - ,:- Il IU
Iocation of the hrst and second contacts, see hgure 15.1. ' ::-tra
:- COI
264
Page No. 263 of 328. .-: Of[
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Heart
l
Body surface Second contact
ria
Voltage source
First contact
ate
Fig. 15.1. Three necessary conditions of electrical accidents,
i.e , voltage source, first contact and second contact
When both contacts are applied to the surface of the body, it is
inown as macroshock. In the case when one contact is applied directly
\
r'j,
yM
o the heart, it is known as microshock. The electric current effects the
:issue in two different ways. When the electric ener5/ is dissipated in
:he tissue it causes temperature rise. A high temperature can damage
:issue i.e., burn. In household cases, electrical burns are normally
-imited to localized damage near contact points i.e. density of the current
-s highest. In the cases of lightening accidents and industrial accidents,
:he dissipated electrical energz may be suff,rcient enough to burn larger
:arts of the body. A generalized model of an electrical accident is shown
.n Figure 15.2, which will be useful in several ways.
Rcz Rt
R, = fault resistance
ud
i gener
Fig. 15.2. A I of an accident
I
l
density is increased further, the heart activity stops completely, but
starts if the current is removed within a short time.
ria
The magnitude of electric current required to produce damaging
effect is dependent on several factors. The figure 15.3 shows the current
ranges and the resulting effects for 1 sec. exposures to various levels of
50 Hz alternating current applied externally to the body.
resl
ate
as1
13 r(
prol
skin
Sustained myocardial resls
contraction (followed
by normal heart 10A
past
rhythm if current is :he i
removed in time. cpen
-ow,
Danger A
yM
of ventricular :ond
fibrillation
::1mt
:: on
:ault.
100 mA
Pain, fatigue, possible
physical injury 15.2.
10 mA
ud
1mA
Threshold of perception
500 pA
l
light finger contact 500 pA
ria
(,4 Firm grasp of the hand 1mA
liil Level of current which is not harmful-unpleasant
and painful <5mA
(iu) Tentanizing effect of muscles, making impossible to 20 mA
"let go" of the conductor.
The voltage required to cause current flow depends on the erectrical
resistance of the body which can vary from few ohms to several ohms
as it is affected by several factors. The largest part of the body resistance
ate
-s represented by the resistance of the skin. The resistance is inversely
croportional to the contact area and also depends on the condition of the
skin. If the skin is cut, the skin resistance is effectively bypassed and
:esistance is that of tissues, which can be as low as 500 f2. Electrode
:aste reduces the resistance of the skin. Many medical activity require
:he insertion of the conductive objects in the body, either through natural
rpenings or through the skin. In such cases, because of the resulting
.ow, dangerously high current can flow in the event of a fault.
A direct contact to the heart can also take place. If electricaly
yM
:onductive catherers are inserted through vein into the heart to apply
stimulating signals from a very worn pacemaker, this provides resistance
rf only few ohms. This may directly effect the heart in case of electrical
-ault.
::re connected to earth (or ground) to bypass the any electrical power
.:akage.
A person must come in contact with both live and neutral conductors
.imultaneously or with both live conductors of a 23o v circuit for an
.lectrical micro shock ltazard. If the neutral wire is connected to earth,
-he same shock hazard exists between live wire and any conductive
-bject which is in a way connected to earth. Insulation breakdornn, wear,
:nd mechanical damage may cause such sjtuations. Room radiators,
St
conductor
l
Neutral conductor ,|
ria
f
n
tr
ate
(The ground (or Earth)
is connected to conduit) Grounding (or Earthing)
(i
,u.:
_on(
230 V
ase
ud
,
Fig. 15.5. Earth (or Ground) shock hazard _-:su
A short between the live wire and the equipment case or box, p . _rffi
230 V on the operator. The exact analysis can be done using hgure 15
15.3.
R, : fault resistance,.i.e., short between live conductor and
case of the equipment T
l
15.3.1. Earthing (or Grounding)
ria
Proper earthing or grounding of equipment is a good protection
method. The ground resistance R, is made so small that the fault current
most of it flows through it. See "figure 15.6, wherein case is connected
to ground through a conductor.
ate \
' '1t,
yM
Fig. 15.6. Protection by introducing equipment earthing
Protection against earthing problem is:
(zJ Hospital grade receptacles and plugs-normally marked
as a green
dot.
(lzj Provision of protection by using tripping of circuit breakers.
15.3.2. Double lnsulation
The equipment case may be made of suitable plastic or whereever
conductive parts exist, they are further insulated from the main box or
case. This is all to ensure R, fault resistance as high as possible. Double
ud
l
15.3.5. lsolation of Patient-Connected Parts
ria
In the use of ECG machines, the patient is subjected to electrodes
or electrical pacemakers. These connections may serve path for fault
currents in case of malfunctions. In older make ECG machines one of
the patient leads used to be connected to power line earthing. This was
a potential danger as grounded patient became one of the two connections
necessary for an electrical accident. The present day technologr allows
designs of circuits which isolate the patient leads from the earth.
ate
Figure 15.7(a) shows older ECG machines monitoring and 15.7(b) shows
present day technologr ECG machine monitoring with current limiters'
The current limiter behaviour is shown in Iigure 15.7(c)
yM
Fis. 15.7. (a)
sionals
)outout
con
'l
Electrical power acl
inout
J
Fig. 15.7. (b)
ud
A
Voltage
I
-1 OpA
+ 10;rA
-----+
Current
<_ +
St
Limiting Limiting
Operating
range range
range
l
ria
solatic n transferme
-----1 SlQni I
Amplifier
Ce rner
ate Demodulator
Filter
\
,jt
ti
yM
ac
SUPP Y
/
output signal
Fig. 15.8. Present day ECG machine showing isolation using transformer
In the figure 15.9 shown, the unit connected to the patient is
completely isolated electrically using isolation transformer from the main
ac supply and also measuring/displaying/monitoring equipments.
ud
St
Reference
Ground and
l
nor the ground line. A separate battery operated circuit supplies power
to the patient circuit. The signal is converted into light by light sources
ria
which is accurately calibrated in frequency and magnitude. When this
light falls on a photodiode, it convertes the light signal into electrical
signal which has its original frequency, amplitude and linearity.
ate
yM
Fig. 15.10. Optical isolation of patient
Instmments such as ECG, pressure monitors, pressure transduced.
pacemakers, etc. are described in this principle. Figure 15.11 shows a
grounding system. A1l the receptacle grounds and conductive surfaces in
the vicinity of the patient are connected to the patient-equipment
grounding point.
Each patient-equipment grounding point is connected to the reference
grounding point which makes a single connection to the building ground
Figure 15.12 shows an arrangement which helps in removing the
patient ground connection by replacing it with an operational amplifie:
ud
.-, th
--
=:-tSI
,, -(u|
r:lt <
| -eSI
: ritr
Page No. 271 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
Receptacles
Reference Ground
Point
ate
To Building Ground
To Other
Patient-Equipment
Grounding-Points
lnstrument Case
Patient's ground Driven
to Zero by Amplifier
l
such cases. Special plugs are used on the earthing wire. These arc
ria
essential requirements of intensive-care units.
ate
(r) Perception threshold of the skin for
light finger contact 500 pA
(ii) Frrm grasp of the hand 1mA
(iii) Level of current which is not harmful-unpleasant
3.'
l
and painful <5mA -1. I
(iu) Tentanizing effecl of muscles, -making impossible 20 mA (
to "let go" of the conductor. 5\
The maximum current which can be tolerated by a person and stil \)
let go of the is Tb
yM
voluntarily conductor called let-go current.
rV
experimentation has proven that the effects of current are almd S
independent of frequency up to about IOOO Hz. -\
2. Shock hazards from electrical equipment: A person rhust come n fr
contact with both live and neutral wire simultaneously or both
conductors of 23O V circuit for an electrical micro shock hazard
the neutral wire is connected to earth. the same shock hazard
between live wire and any conductive object which is in a
connected to earth. Insulation breakdown, wear and mec
damage may cause such situations.
3. Methods of Accident Prevention: The protective methods to ar
accidents are:
ud
l
techniques are used.
Isolated power distribution system: Each room power
ria
made througnh an isolation transformer. Such isoration
supply is
transforms
in conjunction with circuit breakers are mounted in separate
enclosures of distribution box.
ate
methods of accident prevention. ppTU_2003)
I5.2 Describe and explain shock hazards for electricar equipment and prevention
against them. ppTU_2004)
15 3. what is the difference between erectrical
shock and microshock? In what
parts of hospitar microshock hazards are likely to
exisi. (upru-MQpl)
i5.4' what are different shock hazards that can be generated \
equipment and give prevention against them?
from erectrical rLt
\.:
15.5. what is the difference between electrical macroshock UpTU_Mepl)
and microshock? In
what parts of the hospitar are microshock hazards ik;ly
to exist?
yM
(UPTU-MQPs)
I5'6. what is the basic purpose of safety measures
used with erectricarly
susceptible patients?
15 7. why is it so important to maintain the integrity of the grounding
system
for protection against microshock?
aaal
ud
St
l
ria
-_01
ate
in Biomedical lnstrumentation
t .\r
-ll-:1n
-"1: 1Il
r'-.er
:s. fnside this chaPter -:^d(
'.:-- bt
analysis, pulmonary function analysis, automated clinical laborat :- triti
are quite common applications. The development of microprocessor i Thr
boosted medical instrumentation. Microprocessors are incorporatec :-.:fac
Clinical instruments as its capabilities are increased or it is automa:
Thr
Patient monitors are now microprocessor based'
:
The microprocessors and computers have become integral part of
: --rfm
t :-, 30
biomedical instrumentation. Hence, basic study of digital compute: r' ::r tt
St
essential. _-ttto
' _ -*t)
: rfmi
16.1. I THE DIGITAL COMPUTER :- - ple
The computer has computational capability. It can store and retr:t In,
enormous amount of information and is capable of manipulat ,",]le.'
:lav(
Page No. 275 of 328. 276
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
he software.
ria
COMPUTER HARDWARE
\ digital computer has the following configuration as shown in frgure 16. 1.
ate
Fig. 16.1. Digital Computer Architecture
An input unit is provided to read the data, the memory unit stores
-re inprrt data and the computed values. The processing unit interprets
:re instructions and carries out the assigned computational work; and
ther results. It has the capability to perform arithmetic operations,
,haracter manipulation operations, and logical operations. The output
.nit prints, displays or plots the results.
yM
The digital computers have following features:
(r') Built to carryout small variety of instructions.
(izJ Instructions are very simple i.e., add, subtract, read a character,
write a character, colnpare numbers, characters, etc'
(lii) The instructions can be carried out in less than a millionth of a
second.
(iu) Instructions are carried out without any fuss.
(u) No mistakes in carrying out instructions.
A computer may be imagined to be a faithful servant who would
t'
arryout instructions without any hesitations at very high speed without
.rhibiting any emotions. In other words computers are machines which
ud
a
an be programmed to follow instructions without any of their own
6
:riorities or judgements.
The internal working of a digital computer with reference to the
rteraction of its various units are as per hgure 16.2.
The function of a cPU (central Processing unit) is to execute
:( :formation stored in memory. The function of l/O devices such as
s ..:yboard and video monitor is to provide a means of communicating
,itrr trre cPU. The cPU, I/o units and the memory unit are connected
St
rrough strips of wire called a bus. The bus inside a computer carries
:-.formation from one place to another similar to street bus carrying
,:ople from one place to another.
:ll,rc In order to recognize an If o, the computer has an address for the
.:_lrli rme. The address assigned are unique and no two devices are allowed
have same address. The cPU puts the address on the bus, and the
Page No. 276 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
ria
External memory
magnetic tape
(hard drive, high de
ate
Output unit
CBT display
2 Random aceess hard drive r
printer,
I
ir modem,
network
yM
lnstruction
Unit (lU)
Controller
(Program)
Control
signal
generator
Central processing
unit (CPU)
'r
(ir) Greater capacity, smaller cost per minute.
IV
SI
Page No.(iii) Greater
277 of 328.
capacity, greater access time.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
(iir) Increasing access time
ria
(iu) Decreasing frequency of access of the memory by the CPU.
Register
Cache
ate
/ Main memory
/ Magnetic Disk
/ Maqnetic Tape It
Fig. 16.3. Usual memory hierarchy \i
10 "
O *or,*o,
o 10 "
c
o
o 10
0)
a
C) Magnetic disk technology
E
103
a '10'
o
0)
o
ud
o
10'
Magnetic tape
10'
101
l
sequentially access instructions from the memory, interpret eaci-- SS
ria
instruction, send control signals to all parts of the computer to carryou: Ass
the program execution. con
rnsl
A11 the described components are common to all computers, but the=
ma(
implementation can assume a wide variety of forms. It may range fror-
ope
a large scale computer to a microcomputer which are low cost bui-: :nti
around microprocessors. Latge scale computers often cost in crores '::
,{n
rupees and are designed to process large amounts of data at high spee:
:xe(
for a large number of users in batch processing or time sharing bas-.:
ate
3AS
The user's terminals in interface with computer can range fro= :nor
simple teletypewriter to a very elaborate input-output system which mar _tse
include an analog-to-digital converter for interfacing with a:,
,om
instrumentation system. led
Computers can communicate with users in an interactive -: rstr
conversational mode. The user may use keyboard and get output frl-
.
l
rssemblers. The mnemonic language is called an assembly language.
\ssembly language programming is very easy, but is specific to a
ria
:omputer. Most computers have compilers and interpreters which accept
:nstructions in languages which are problem oriented which convert into
nachine language. These languages use terminologr, symbols, and the
rperations which are familiar to the user. A compiler goes through the
:ntire program and translates every instruction before execution begins.
rn interpreter translates the high-level program a step at a time and
:xecutes each step as it proceeds. The high level languages are FORTRAN,
3ASIC, COBAL, etc. The system software are known as supervisor,
ate
:nonitor, executive or operating system. Medical instrumentations may
lse specific software which are suitable for the purpose. The same
:omputer at user end can have separate software for various applications.
ledicated computers and softwares are in use in the case of clinical
nstrumentation and such computers are known as turnkey systems. \
.he very large scale integration (VLSI) technologies have brought up the
yM
levelopments such that powerful CPUs are available on single chip and
his has been termed microprocessor. The large scale integration has
.Jso happened on RAMs and ROMs also. This has facilitated complete
omputer at very low cost with reasonably high speed. Although the
:omplexity of integrated circuits has increased greatly, but the prices
:ave decreased. In consequence, complex microcontrollers are available
i'hich are comparable to minicomputers capability-wise. The biomedical
rstrumentation has been enriched by use of microcontrollers.
16.4.1. Types of Microprocessors
The intel's 8O8O microprocessor was the world's hrst general purpose
ricroprocessor. This was an 8 bit machine, with 8-bit data path to
ud
lemory. 8086 is 16 bit machine having wider data path and larger
egisters, it has instruction cache that perfetches a few instructions
:efore they are executed. 80286 is an extension of the 8086 which
:nabled addressing a 16 M Byte memory instead of 1 M Byte. 80386 is
-rst 32-bit machine. 80486 introduced the use of much more sophisticated
atche technologr and sophisticated instruction sets.
Pentium introduces the use of superscalar techniques which allow
rultiple instructions for execution in parallel.
St
l
v
ria
I
A
ir
ate
1t
Power Clock b5
Lines Lines ta
)r (b) Processor signals 1(
16r
lhe
aenr
,r v
_:tto
ud
te
16.5
I
-ard
- -rffr
_: di
f
St
- ata
:..ria
_--:erl
_-.:u1
(c) Microcomputer system block diagram ., -. I
Fig. 16.5. A microcomputer block diagram ":-.
Page No. 281 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Microprocessors and Computers in Biomedical lnstrumentation 283
l
ways:
ria
L6.4.2.1. Calibration
Some instruments require zeroing and recalibration every few hours.
A software or hardware timer in a microprocessor system is able to
initiate a calibration cyc1e. Microprocessor based devices perform
calibration in digital form as such during calibration offset and gain
correction factors are determined and stored in memory to be applied to
the rneasured data during the measurement.
ate
16.4.2.2. Table lookup
In analog systems non-linear functions of transducers are corrected
by straight-line approximations. However, in microprocessor-based system,
table lookup with interpolation can be used. This offers more accuracy.
L6.4.2.3. Averaging
Microprocessors decrease statistical variations by easily averaging
data over successive measurements
16.4.2.4. Formatting and Printout
yM
The microprocessor based medical equipment process data in digital
iorm, therefore, data can be formatted, convert raw data into physical
rnits and printout the results in such form which does not require
:urther processing.
l
Interchange (ASCII), etc.
ria
1
ate
cost these are decided. 1r
The digital to analog converter can be weighted register type digital-
to-analog converter using operational amplifiers. The other type of digital
al
to Analog converter can be binary-ladder type again using operational re
ampliher. Analog filters are also used in such cases'
There section of analog to digital converter or digital to analog 1t
converter depends on the total scheme of the circuitry. It may involve
multiplexing of data circuitry as well. 1n
qu
16.6. BIOMEDICAL COMPUTER APPLICATIONS rel
yM
The use of digital computer in medicine is very wide and common. The 16
b4sic capabilities are:
16.6.1. Data Acquisition ott
the
The computer automatically reads the instrument by transcribin: sol_
the data. The computer scans all input sources and accept data whic:- Itr
are produced. If the data is analog. Analog to Digital converter is usei
Automatic calibration and trouble diagnostic are built alongwith.
16.;
16.6.2. Storage and Retrieval
The data stored in a hospital in computer can be admission, dischargt
ud
The
information, physicians report, laboratory test results, and other patie:--: Con
related information. Hospital also generates computer data of pharma..-. itavt
records, inventories of all types and accounting records, etc. The digr:' som
computer not only stores these data, but also retrieves as and whe:-
needed. 16.7
::le I
informations by analysis and or some transformations like Fou:--t: :sed
transformation to obtain frequency spectrLlm of the signal in the case x
EEG. Similarly, heart rate information can be deduced from ECG. Infa-*- 16.7.
such transformation and reduction of data would not have been feas::'c
L
without digital computers.
=bor
Page No. 283 of 328. _ _ood
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
are derived from calculations and manipulations. Some respiratory
parameters can be calculated from simple breathing tests. These results
ria
are made available to the physician while measurements are in progress.
16.6.5. Pattern Recognition
Analysis of the ECG waveform is done by recognition of important
amplitudes and intervals of the ECG. Computer programs are available
for searching and identiry certain characteristics of ECG. A11 this is
known as pattern recognition technique using digital computers.
ate
16.6.6. Limit Detection
The computerized monitoring and screening helps in identifying
automatically when limit of a parameter is exceeded. If it is found,
rernedial actions can be initiated by system or a physician.
l1\
16.6.7. Data Presentation
t'-
The measured data can be easily converted by the digital computer
in the form of tabular printouts, graphs, and charts to facilitate better
quick understanding of the patient's condition to initial appropriate
remedial actions.
yM
16.6.8. Control Functions
The computers are programmed to control physiological, chemical or
other measurements from the source of data. The automatic feedback
theory can be built in the computer such that it can compensate for
some sources of error by altering the process or mathematical adjustment.
It may stop if it goes too much errorneous.
the result for easy usage by physician. Statistical techniques can also be
used in such analysis to establish certain abnormalities.
16.7.2. The Digital Computer in the Clinical Laboratory
In a well automated system computer participates in clinical
laboratory. The computer accepts test requisitions, prepares lists for
drawing,
bloodNo.
Page of 328. for loading sample trays, reads test results,
284 schedules
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
Computerized and controlled displays of systolic and diasystolic blood
pressures and heart rate are available for patient monitoring.
ria
A computer based cardiac surgical intensive care unit is shown in
figure 16.6(a\.
ate
Computer
C
t
C
)\
fi
ir
Fig. 16.6. (a) Computer based cardiac care C(
t1
Several peripherals of Input/Output including biomedical instru-
mentation exist to provide complete integration, processing, displaying
yM
/,/ and medical manipulation systems. It is real time monitoring, automated.
corrective and caring system which is achieved using digital computer'
16.7.4. Computer in the Aid of Handicapped
Computerized automobiles for physically handicapped are available.
Microprocessors control wheel chair in limiting speed, acceleration.
deceleration and braking. Such equipments can be computerized for
helping patients-for loss of limb, paralysis, speech defects, blindness.
etc.
Electromyoelectric limbs are available to provide functions of naturd
limb, which are computerized, may be microprocessor based.
ud
l
Microprocessor
based
system
ria
Fig. 16.6. (b) Prosthesis arm
Figure 16.7 shows schematic system which includes a data acquisition
and control system. This is an use of digital computer in surgical intensive
care automation.
ate
Figure 16.8 shows an on-line ECG analysis system. The patient is
connected to a three-channel ECG data acquisition system. ECG from
the patient site to the cornputer site is transmitted directly over
conventional telephone lines.
The system permits the operator to dial the computer center directly
from the bedside and 12-lead trCG is transmitted in 3 leads simultaneously
in analog from to the computer center. The trCG is analyzed at the
computer center which can be transmitted back to patient location again
through telephone lines.
Video
yM
Terminals
Controllers
o_o
l
ria
Print out from Data
Transmitted Back
from Computer Site Computer (ECG lnterpretative
System)
ate
Magnetic Tape for
ECG Storage
yM
Fig. 16.9. Computerized ECG analysis with magnetic tape storage
This technique is suitable for off-line uses t.
16.
16.
16.
1. Digital Computer: The digital computer has computational capabilil,
16.
It can store and retrive enormous amount of information and is
capable of manipulating instruction based on calculated results. Th
16.
instruction set sequence for a given tab is known as a prograrn
ud
Digital computer can be divided into two parts namely hardware anc
software.
2. Computer Hardware: Computer consists of input/output devices
Memory unit, Central Processing unit with address bus and dau
bus; and also means of communication among various units.
J- Computer Software: Software is a program used by computer r:
solve a problem. It can be divided in two categories. One is syste::
software and the other is application software. The same compute:
St
l
generate analog data in the form of voltage proportional to the
ria
parameters or variable represented. For interfacing, the analog signals
are converted into digital data. In the case of computer output data
for display purposes, the digital data has to be converted into analog
signal.
7. Biomedical computer Applications: The use of digitial computer in
biomedical is vety wide and common. The features of computer which
are exploited for biomedical applications are data acquisition, data
storage and retrieval, data reduction ald transformation, mathematical
ate
operation, pattern recognition, limit detection data presentation,
control functions, etc.
8. Specific exarnples of biomedical applications of computer:
Computerized Axil Tomography (CAT) scanners, Emission
Computerized Tomography, Computer analysis of the ECG, digital \.
computer usage in clinical laboratory, digital computer in patient \2..
t
monitoring, computer in the aid of handicapped, Microprocessor based
Myoelectric arm, Microprocessor based hearing aids, digital computer
usage in surgical intensive care automation, computer assisted online
yM
ECG system, etc.
txercided
16.1. Describe digital computer with a block diagram.
16.2. What do you understand by computer hardware and software?
16.3. How a microprocessor can be used in biomedical application?
16.4. What do you understand by analog to digital and digital to analog
conversion? How these are used in biomedical instrumentation?
16.5. Explain use of digital computer in biomedical application and give some
examples.
ud
aaa
St
lnpL
(less
freqr
used
l
amp
ria
AS ST
etc. I
chan
comp
circui
a.nalo
rold
Basic Electronics for T}
ate
:s an
Biomedical lnstrumentation :num
.dvan
-'mpe
nzlt
>* fnside thts chapter
,re dil
17.1. Operational Amplifiers - has
\7.2. Basic Operational Amplifier Circuit :ASS
yM
Ci
17.3. Details of Commercial Operational Amplifiers Thr
17.4. Measurement of Inductance and Capacitance with the Help of -.
figur
A.C. Bridges -_fut c
',
17.5. Measurement of Inductance -tat h
17.6. Measurement of Capacitance Wht
17.7. Cat}lode Ray Oscilloscope t" ---ich c
,:ease
The details of basic electronic circuit are given in this chapter. Thest ----lnv(
details are very important for Doctors and paramedical staff using th:s :,\/hel
book. :::asel
The basic electronic component like operational amplifier and othe: I :-ge I
electronic circuits like bridged and cathode ray oscilloscope are ve- ::tlng
important.
3,/ot
St
l
amp was originally designed to perform mathematical operations such
ria
as summation, subtraction, multiplication, differentiation and integration
etc. Now-a-days op-amps are put to a variety of other uses such as sign
:hanging, scale changing, phase shifting, voltage regulation, analog
,-omputer operations, in instrumentation and control systems, oscillator
:ircuits, pulse generators, square, triangular wave generators comparators,
a.nalog to digital converters, voitage to current converters, sample and
rold circuits, etc.
The op-amp manufactured with integrated tralsistors, diodes, resistors
ate
:s an extremely versatile device that is found doing countless tasks as
:numerated above. The op-amp is a high gain amplifier having the
advantage of an IC such as low cost, small size, high reliability
emperature stability and low value of offset voitage and current.
5\
\.
17.2. BAS!C OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER GIRCUIT '14
.a
lhe differential ampliher is widely employed in integrated circuitry because
has both good bias stability and high gain without requiring large by .i
:ass capacitors.
yM
The differential amplifier circuit that is used in IC op-amps is given
r lrgure 17 .1(c). This is the circuit which explains a great deal about the
rput characteristics of the typical iC op-amps. Here is the basic idea of
'.'hat happens in this differential amplifier.
When input (i.e., V1l increases the emitter current of Q, increases
'.hich causes the voltage at the top of emitter resistance R, to increase
-quivalent to decreasing Vr" of transistoy Qz. Reduction in Vru of
'.ansistor Q2 means less current in this transistor. The voltage drop in
rllector resistance Ra is decreased and output voltage 7or, being the
::fference of collector supply voltage I/." and voltage drop in collector
-:sistance R" (i.e.,IaR.) is increased. Thus we see increase in V, causes
ud
:-crease in output voltage. That is why the input voltage 7, is called the
rn-inverting input. The output voltage %.,, i" in phase with 7r.
When input 7, increases, the collector current to transistoy Qz
:-creases causing more voltage drop in collector resistance and so output
rltage Vou, to decrease. This is why the input voltage V, is called the
-r'erting input. The output voltage Vou, is 180' out of phase with 7r.
St
s
-anufactured by various other manufacturers.
l
RCA cA 3747
Texas Instruments sN5274 1 loul
ria
Signetics N5741
The last three digits in all the manufacturer's number are 74[ 1..,
indicating that alt these op-amps have same specif,rcations and therefore
:urr
lea
behave the same waY.
>tag(
Figure 17.1 shows the connection terminals for a single 741 op-ary
in a dual-in-line package and figure 17.2 shows the connection terminab =ost
:l th
for a 741 enclosed in a metal can package. From figure 1 and 2 it s
ate
::nit1
obvious that there are two input terminals (input 2 and 3) and oc ;tlta
output terminals (pin 6) both a positive (pin 7) and a negative (pin {
\on-i
supply voltage must be Provided.
tr
Offset nv(
Off set NC nul -:-
null tn
lnverting
input lnverting
input
Now inverting Output
yM
input
Non inverting ofisel dr
Offset input T}
null ::-fere
V-
c:pli1
(a) Top view of dead-in-line package (b) Top vew of metal can Package lr ':pu
r.-de
f,<a-rr(
ElaaSU
k-- :he
th
:put
:alle
ud
: ','olt
:cut
The
twe
i:rrn(
;'rta
(c) Circuit used in op-amP
to
St
To keep the amplifrer free from common mode undesired signals- :ES \
from pick-ups, etc. neither of its input terminals should be groun -al.
This can be achieved by using differential input mechanism in rit l
both the input terminals are at same voltage level with respect to :ntie
one terminal is non-inverting terminal and the other is inverting lhe
r---:ier
Page No. 291 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
The block diagram given in figure 17.2 consists of a four stage direct
ria
coupled amplifier in cascade. stagewise explanation is given below.
The first stage is a double ended high-gain (60 db) differential amplifrer
1.e., dual-input balanced output differential amplifier with a constant
current source. in this stage high gain is desirable so that there would
be a negligible effect on the output of any short coming in the following
stages. 1ti" i" the reason why this stage is generally responsible for
*o"t of the gain of op-amp. Also this stage determines the input resistance
of the op-amps. output of this stage is taken between collectors of two
ate
emitter biased circuits so that output remains balanced and the dc
uoltage at output in quiescent condition maintains zero level.
\
le,
,.
l
amplifrer with resPect to ground. eq
ria
Uses of Operational AmPllfier
The oper with other componen:
are being us , as subtraction' It caf:
be used as i an be used for currec:
to voltage conversion and voltage to current conversron' anr
ate
HELP OF A.C. BRIDGES 17.
trlc
yM
t lmpedance
Flg. 17.3.
when the points B and D are at the same potential and voltage
between A and B and A and D will be equal'
ud
Hence,
zt 23
Z. ZN
Z. Z" = Z^2,
Page No. 293 of 328.t+zo
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Basic Electronics for Biomedical lnstrcirnentation 295
l
equation can be,
(21 < e)(24 . 0o) = (22 < e2)(23 < 03)
ria
ZrZo = ZrZ,
Z0r+ l0+= l0r+ lg,
Note: Just like d.c. bridge there is no affect by interchange of supply
and detector terminals, though sensitivity might get affected.
There are various types of bridges and can be studied one by one.
ate
MEASUREMENT OF INDUCTANGE
R.-R"
Rr , juLr R3 jaLz
R2 R2 R4 R3
equating real and imaginary parts
R1 R3
R2 R" IReal]
St
*t
"lD : R" ^o,
otrr aLz
R2-R4 IImaginary]
r
,R+"3Rn
17
L.=
Thus, value of unknown self-inductance can be determined.
l
Et=Ez
ria
l',R', = lrR.
Vr=|.,R, = laRo
ate
E -E
L3-L4
\ K- E, -+F- E3 +l
yM
F Ez Eo ---N
Et=Ez
ud
l
From the Fig. 17.6 we see that:
1'r : unknown inductance
ria
R, = effective resistance of 'L,
R3, R2 : known, non-inductive resistance
Co = standard variable capacitance
Ro = variable resistance
ate
yM
Fig. 17.6. Circuit diagram showing Maxwell's lnductance-capacitance Bridge
ZrZo = ZrZ" lBalance equation of a Balanced Bidgel
(R^)
1R, + jrol,,)i*,id_,J = (R3XR2)
RrRo = RrR.
p- xzraln"al partl
'tl R"
LrR+: C4R4R2R3
L, : COR,R, [Imaginary parts]
Hence, the unknown inducta.nce
St
L, = CoRrR,
Expression for Q factor:
O=+ =,r,tCa,Rc
Advantages:
(zJ The two balance equation are independent if we choose Ro and Co
as variable elements.
(iz) The frequency does not appear in any equation
l
(iizJ This bridge yield a simple expression for R, and L,
ria
(iu) The Maxwell's inductance and capacitance bridge can be very useful
for measurement of a wide range of inductance at power and audio
frequency.
Disadvantages:
(zJ The bridge requires a variable standard capacitance which may be
very expensive if calibrated to a high degree of accuracy. Therefore
sometimes a hxed standard capacitor is used, either because a
ate
variable capacitor is not available or fixed, is less expensive and
have high degree of accuracy. Then the balance adjustments are
done by:
(a) either varying R, and Ro and since R, appears in both balar'..
equation the balance adjustments become difficult.
(b) putting an additional resistance in series with the inductan'-.
to be measured and varying Ro.
(izJ The bridge is limited to measurement of low Q coils (1 < Q < 10
It is cleat that,
yM
= 'L, = roR, c,
o-Rl'ta
Measurement of high Q coils demands a large value for resistancr
or 106 fl. The resistance boxes of such high values a-
Ro, perhaps 1Os
very expensive.
Thus, for Q > 10 Maxwell Bridge in unsuitable.
The M is also unsuitable for coils less than 1(Q. 1). Qvalues of ti-:s
magnitude occur in inductive resistors or in R.F. coil if measured at icr"r
frequency. The difficulty in measurement occurs on account of labo's
involved in obtaining balance
7.., L, = RrCoR,
ud
R. R"
D
-
^,,R+
Normally for convenience
- a fixed capacitor is used, therefore we h
to vary R, and Ro. Now' since R, is in both the equation. Therefore it
balance R, and get a balance position, but again when we want to
an inductive balance then the resistive balance gets disturbed and he
moves to new values giving slow 'convergence'to balance. This condi
St
l
ria
lrRt lR E. = 1.,R.= E,
l.
=fr= t*no
ate
17.5.3. Hay's Bridge
The Hay's bridge is modification of Maxwell bridge. Here we can see
frorn the figure 17.8.
yM
Co = standard capacitance
At balance,
G ( ; \
E (R, + jrrrl,l)l Ra +,* I = n"n
1 Jtuee.) "-
( ; \
(R, + jrol,)[n+ -
@L
fr )= RsRz
St
R,Ro+*=*r*,
t-4
[Real part]
=.
l
.ilLrRo- [Imaginary part]
#
ria
-
R, = '-[*"R" - lll
&L^t^'-co.l
coa2LrRo - Rr = o
ate
=o
,,1,' co RZ.
+l = RsRz
1,, = R3R2laer)
, _ RsRzC+
tJt -
yM
a2 cl nl +t
aL. 1
Disar
V= & -rcoRo
a)
This expression contains a frequency term, therefore, it appears ttIA
the frequency of the source of supply to the bridge must be accuratelr
17.5.4
known. But it does not hold for inductance when high Q coil is measured
OS, T}
re
St
ob
Lt=
1
Now, 0= rulCaRa
hence,
l
ria
For the value of e > 10 the t".- -1: would be smaller tfr"r,
@)2 fr
and can be neglected, therefore, equation reduces to:
L, = C*RrR,
ate
yM
lrl.ucCo
high Q coils. It's value should be small. Thus, this bridge requires
very low value of Ro whereas Maxwell's bridge requireds parallel
resistor Ro of very high value.
ud
Disadvantages:
(t) The Hay's bridge is suited for the measurement of high inductors,
e
especially those inductors having a e greater than 10.
17.5.4. Anderson's Bridge
This bridge is also used for measuring inductance from figure lr.lo,
we observe,
St
'
L, = Self-inductance to be measured
R, = Resistance of self-inductor
r, = resistance connected in series with I,
r, R2, R4, Ra = known non-inductive resistance
C = fixed standard capacitor.
Page No. 300 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Ir. -- Ie and I, = I, + Io
(Considering the currents)
l
ria
[1
r 11,
Let us assume that bec to be as loop
IrRs= 1"" jrc
I, = IrRjt.roC
1
ate
Fig. 17.10. Circuit diagram showing Anderson's bridge
1. Adv
(r
yM
Now, let us assume bad as looP 2.
Writing other balance equations
4(R1 + jaLr+ 11)= \Rr+ Ir7 (ii
(iii
tr,
- *Js; : R+I+ = g, - Ig)R+ vo= b-
JOU
( r)
lglr+,-l=U2-lg)R* -
Disa
(,)
I J") -
(
Iglr+ :t )I = U2-
-
tc)R4-
\ J") FA
ud
jcoR3crl
't['- +] = U, -1,jrocR.lRo
JCDC_I
jaRrClrr + R:1r = bRo - lrTrrlCR.Ro
IrLjiur'Rrcr * R. * jroCR.Ra) = IzR+
St
R:Rs
=
B',R+ -'
t, = + Rr)+ RrRo]
"X[r(Ra
Page No. 301 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
E
;41 -
l
ria
ate S
l1(R', + r',; E. = 1., R. =,,
bridge.
17.5.5. Owen's Bridge
-L,= unknown self-inductor
R, : variable non-inductive resistance
Ra = fixed non-inductive resistance
C, : variable capacitance
St
l
ria
(
1R,j,or,)i#;l =
Z,
t \
Ll --
r
L*-*l*
R2R3C4
ate
Fig. 17.12. Circuit diagram showing Owen's Bridge
: R,I,
'-1
yM
91
R. = ,R""cz
'
Advantages:
(rJ Since, C, ar:d R, are in the same branch, convergence to balance
condition is much easier.
(irJ Balance equation do not contain any frequency term.
(iir) It can be used over wide range of measurement of inductances.
Adr
,Disadvantages:
(tJ This requires a variable capacitance whose accuracy is about 1o.,;
and is expensive.
ud
E.=E, = I
0U.t
St
-lz
acz
l
ria
C, = standard capacitance
R3, R4 = non-inductive resistance
Applying balance equations,
ate
Fig. 17.14. Circuit diagram showing De-Sauty's Bridge
C, : unknown capacitance
yM
It-lcrro,;
[
)*,=liacz
' )l*,'
I
."r=CzR+
&
Hence, the capacitance can be known.
Advantage / Disadvantage
. l,t
ud
St
|,2,
Fig. 17.15.
l
AS:
ria
Note: r, and 12 represent loss component of two capacitor.
Il R, *n *--i,r-1lR+ = tlRz +rr *.l-ln, "]
ate
aCrrr- aCrr, = ro(CrR, - C2R2\ (0
Now, consider the vector diagram given below:
l,ttt lztz lzRz lrRr EzEq
I
yM
lt _ lz Ecr Ecz E.=E" F
toCl roC,
Fig. 17.16.
From this diagram, we can see that, 6, and 6, are phase angles of
capacitors C, and C, dissipation factor for the capacitors are:
D, = tan 6, = roCrr,
D, = tan6r= aCrr,
Putting their values in (tj
Dz - Dt: ro(Crr, - C2r2l
ud
:)L
tr
l
ria
R. = non-inductive resistance
Co = variable capacitor
Ro = variable resistance
C, = unknown capacitance
r, = series resistance
C, = standard capacitance
ate
Fig. 17.17. Circuit diagram showing Schering bridge
yM
[either air or gas capacitor which is free from losses]
At balance,
tI r +_ 1l[| R4
, ]| _ r D
L yrC, _][ t + Tcoco _]
- '"3 _
J0C2
R" C,
,.=u-
,CZ
')
c.r = c^zln"
l,*-
I
\ J,/
ud
D, = tanS = 1
= *ol[o.,
^l', "* I
LR.lLc2l
Rs c+
where, .1
C2
D, = atCoRo
St
vantages:
(l) Capacitance can be read directly, as R. is only variable and
hence
can be set easily.
il Dt : wCoR4, if frequency is fixed the dial of capacitor is adjusted
to obtain balance to get directly dissipation factor.
Page No. 306 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Disadvantages:
Since R. appears in both the equations hence there is some difference
in obtaining the balance.
l
ria
l
(
(
',=,.r=L
ate
' @Lz
l
beam. Now electron beam deflects in two direcbions, horizontal on X-axis
ria
and vertical on Y-axis. A triggering circuit is provided for synchronizing
two types of deflections so that horizontal deflection starts at the same
point of the input vertical signal each time it sweeps. A basic block
diagram of a general purpose oscilloscope is shown in figure lr.l9.
cathode ray tube and its various components are d.iscussed below.
Luminous
ate
spot
.a- Screen
Electron
beam
Horizontal
deflection
plates
yM
Fig. 17.19. Block diagram of a general purpose CRO
Focusing
anode
Y-plates Fluorescent
Electron
beam
ud
Cathode
Accelerator
anodes
X-plates
St
,1"
l
I
ria
17.8.1. Electron Gun AssemblY t
Electron gun assembly indirectly heated cathode a c
b
T
surrounding the cathode, a focusing anode and an accelera
The sole function of the electron gun assembly is to provide 1
screen' The
electron beam which is accelerated, towards the phospher
cathode is a nickel cylinder coated with an oxide coating and emits
pi
plentyofelectron"*h..'heated.Theemittingsurfaceofthecathode on at
be as small as possible. Intr nsitY of electron beam depends
ate
pl
the cathode current, *^rri.r, can be controlled by the control grid' hole
"fro-.ria The
ce
control grid is a metal cylinder covered at one end but with a small
pl
in the 'fhe grid is kept at negative potential (variable) with respecl
"orr".. emission and so the th
e hole in the grid is wi
and concentrate the If
uF
the tube. Electron beam comes ou:
is
from the control grid through a small hole in it and enters a is pre-
aCl
cylinder and a:
accelerating anodel which is in the shape of a hollow ap
yM
apotelltial-of.f.*hundredvoltsmorepositivethenthecathodesoas the
to acceler:ate the electron beam in the electric field. This accelerate-
and u'ou-: the
beam worrlll be scattered now because of variations in enerS' am
am ::
produce a broad ill-defined spot on the screen' This ofl
mo::
iocussed orr the screen by an electrostatic lens consi
cylindrical anode called ih" fo.'""ing anode and a ano:=
ussing and acceleratl:i inr
apart from the pre-accelerating ofr
anodes may be open or close at f covered' holes must :t
provided in-the anode cover for the e electrons' The funct-: 17.1
tf th."" anodes is to concentrate and focus the beam on the scfeefl ?i:l
also accelerate the speed of electrons' prol
An eiectrostatic focussing system is shown in figure 17'-'-
ud
a: E fluo
Electrostatic lens consists of three anodes, with the middle
anode
conl
iower potential than the other two electrodes'
callr
Pre-accelerating Focussing
- Acceleratirrg :1me
anode anode anode Screen
'he I
.----/
':----:l -,\rhe
1
__--J
----l
rn tl
St
: lect
amOl
:reer
a-vlnj
l:COf
,.
hite
Page No. Fig. 17.21. Electrostatic focussing system of a CRT
309 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
iens, formed between two anodes at different potentials, it is focused at
ria
the phospher screen. Focai length of the electrostatic lens can be adjusted
by varying potential of middle anode with respect to other tr,,,o anodes.
Thus, the electron beam can be made to focus at the screen very precisely.
17.8.2. Deflection Plate Assembly
Electron beam after leaving the electron gun, passes through the two
pair of deflection plates. One pair of deflection plates is mounted vertically
and deflects the beam in horizontal or X-direction and are ca-lled horizontal
ate
plates and the other plates are mounted vertically in Y-direction and are
called Vertical plate and deflects and beam in vertical direction. These
plates are to deflect the beam according to the voltage applied across
them. If the potential difference is applied on horizontal plates the beam
will be deflected in the horizontal direction according to potential applied.
If positive potential difference is applied on the vertical plates and the
upper plate is positive them the beam will be deflected upward. This
is correct for the beam to travel left, right or upward and downward
according to potential difference applied. In case a sinusoidal voltage is
applied on the horizontal plates and the frequency is more t}ran 16 Llz
yM
the deflection will be a horizontal line. If the potentiai is applied to both
the plates simultaneously, the deflection will be an oblique line. The
amount of deflection is in proportion to the voltage applied to the pair
of plates.
We knorv that a force is experienced by an electron when it is kept
in a uniform electronic fie1d. This principle is the basis for the deflection
of electron beam owing to deflection plates.
17.8.3. Screen for CRT
It is known that some crystaline materials such as phosphor have
property of emitting light when exposed to radiation. This is called
lluorescence characteristic of materials. These fluorescent materials
ud
continue to emit light even after radiation exposure is cut off. This is
called the phosphorescence charat:teristic of the materials. The length of
time during which phosphorescence occurs is called the persistence of
the phosphor.
The end wall of the CRT is ca.lled screen is coated with phosphor.
When eiectron beam strikes the CIRT screen, a spot of iight is produced
on the screen. The phosphor absorLrs the kinetic enerry of the bombarding
St
l
The whole assembly is protected in a conical highly evacuated glass
ria
housing through suitable supports. The inner wells of the CRT between
neck and screen are usually coated with a conducting material known
as aquadag and this coating is electrically connected to the accelerating
anode. The coating is provided in order to accelerate the electron beam
after passing between the deflection plates and to collect the electrons
produced by secondary emission when electron beam strikes the screen.
Thus the coating prevents formation of negative charge on the screen
and state of equilibrium of screen is maintained.
ate
The horizontal and vertical marks are marked on the screen of the
CRT to provide user a correct measurement.
17.8.5. Basic Control
Number of controls are required to be provided for adjustment of
\ brightness of the spot on the screen. It is accomplished by varying the
q,
voltage between the first and second anodes. The horizontal and verticai
position controls are provided for moving the beam on any part of the
screen. It is accomplished by applying a dc voltage to horizontal or
vertical deflection plates. Other controls are discussed in detail.
yM
A detailed block diagram of CI{O may be seen at figure 17.22.
17.8.6. Vertical Deflection System
The function of the vertica-l deflection system is to provide an amplified
signal of the proper level to drive the vertical deflection plates withour
introducing any appreciable distortion into the system.
The input sensitivity of many CRO's is of the order of a few milli-volts
per division and the voltage required lbr deflecting the electron bearr,
varies from approximately 10OV (peak to peak) to 500 V depending or-
accelerating voltage and the construct-ion of the tube. Thus the vertica-
amplifier is required to provide this desired gain from millivolt input tc
ud
several hundred volt (peak to peak) output. Also the vertical amplifie:
should not distort the input wavelbrrn and should have good respons.
for entire band of frequencies to be rneasured.
-t'he deflection plates of CRO erct as plates of a capacitor and whe:.
the input signal frequency exceeds I MHz, the current required fc:
charging and discharging of the capacitor formed by the deflection plate =
increases. So, the vertical amplifier shr:uld be capable of supplying curre:--
enough to charge and discharge the deflection plate capacitor.
St
a
c)
l
c o
o o-
c o- o c
ria
a o .9
F6 E o
o
63
o
f
o
o) 0)
Eq)
o! cqJ .c o E
o) C
D o- o E ,lQ
c)
6: o
f
) N o.Y
(rb
i
E ! o)
U)
(E o
o)
c!
o) c
o -
oc o) I
C
b(o (U
oY'
o.= 0) 6
oa
(E= 0) EC
oo
o
ate
99 N=
dlI ra
q&
E;
ILO
o
E
o)
yM
o)
(E.
o
I
@
f,
Oo
tso
oo
CA
a
ud
oo
lcE
lJu
6E
St
l
to allow the operator to see the leading edge of the signal waveform
under study on the screen. For this purpose, delay line circuit is
ria
introduced between vertical amplifier and the plates of CRT as shown in
figure 17 .22.
17.8.7. Horizontal Deflection System
External signal is applied to horizontal deflection plates through the
horizontal amplifier at the sweep selector switch in EXT position as
shown in figure 17.22. The horizontal amplifier, simila-r to the vertical
ate
amplifier increases the amplitude of the input signal to the level requirei
by the l:,orizontal deflection plates of CRT.
When the function of time is required to be displayed on the screec
of CRT, INT position of sweep selector switch is used. The linear tim:
base pattern is described below.
\ Assume that an ideal saw tooth voltage is supplied to the horizonta- tt
,l
l; deflection plates, keeping vertical deflection plates at zero potential a. vt
shown in figure 17.23. di
VC
)
yM
of
A----> B -----------) C ho
dir
VCI
an
SYS
screen. Just after the point C, next cycle of saw tooth voltage s- S\TNC
::me
starts and again voltage becomes maximum negative so the spot =-
back to the extreme left position of the screen from right position :;- I,
time. :ecel
St
l
ria
ate
applied
(a) Voltage signal signal
(b) Sawiooth wave voltage (c) pattern of signal on
deflection
to vertical applied tohorizontal screen of CRo
plates deflection plates
Fig. 17.24.
At zero time, the spot is at extreme left vertically control position on
the screen because of zero value of Id and maximum negative voltage of
vh. At time T l4 the spot is at one fourth way on the screen in horizontal
direction and at maximum positive deflection above the centre line in
vertical direction because of maximum positive value of Vu. At tine Tl
2, values of both VrandVnare zero, so the spot is at the central position
yM
of the screen. At time 3Tl4 tlne spot is at the three fourth way in
horizontal direction and at the maximum negative deflection in vertical
direction. Finally, at the end of time I the spot is at extreme right
vertically central position of the screen and then it moves back to begin
a new trace. In this way sine-wave voltage applied to the vertical deflection
system appears on the screen. If the period of sine-wave is reduced to
half then two sine-wave cycle appears on the screen.
The following conditions are to be satisfied to get a waveform of the
input signal applied to vertical deflection system as a stationary pattern
on the screen of the CRO.
(a) both horizontal and vertical signals must start at the same instant.
ud
base and controls the rate at which the beam is scanned across the face
of the CRT. Time base generation is triggered or initiated by a trigger
circuit which ensures that the horrzontal sweep starts at the same point
of the vertical input signal.
It is necessary to synchronise the sweep with the signal under
measurement to obtain a stationary pattern. Ratio of the frequency of
time base and the signal under measurement should be a rational number,
Page No. 314 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
V(
In the external position of switch, the trigger is obtained from the u
ria
external source. In the third position of switch, i.e.,line trigger is obtained
1i
from the power supply i.e., 23O V and 50 Hz.
Two types of sweep generator are usually used. In the hrst one
sawtooth signal of constant frequency is generated whether there is any sq
input signal or not. That is why it is called free running type. In this it
is essential to adjust the frequency of the sawtooth signal to get stationary
pattern. In the second type of sweep generator, sweep is triggered by the
n
signal under measurement so there is no need for any adjustment for CR
ate
synchronisation. vol
There are two knobs, one for controlling the horizontal position and
another for controlling the vertical position. The spot can be moved to diff(
left or right, i.e., horizontally with the help of a knob, which regulates ellip
t the
the dc potential applied to the horizontal deflection plates, in addition to
the usual sawtooth wave. Similarly, the spot can be moved up and down. an(
i.e., vertically with the help of attother knob, which regulates the dc diffe
,]
potential applied to the vertical deflection plates in addition to the signal.
yM
repri
17.8.9. lntensity Control figu.
The potential of the control grid with respect to cathode is controllec Cu ar
with the help of potentiometer in order to control the intensity o:
brightness of the spot.
17.8.10. Focus Control
In the electron gun of the CRT middle anode is kept at lower potentia--
with respect to other two anodes and it acts like an electrostatic ler-=
and focal length of this lens can be varied by varying the potential of th=
middle anode with respect to other two anodes. So, focusing of a:-
ud
electron beam is done by varying the potential of middle anode with r:.-
help of potentiometer as shown in figure 17 .19. By increasing the posit:-" -
potential applied to the focusing anode the electron beam can be nalro\\'-:
and the spot on the screen can be made a pin point.
17.8.11. Blanking Circuit
Sawtooth sweep voltage is applied to horizontal deflection plates '.9.2.
the CRT which moves the spot on the screen following a straight horizo:.-.
St
line from left to right during the sweep period. When the spot mc'- The
slowly so that its rate of movement exceeds the threshold of persiste:. CR(
vision, the spot appears as a solid line. Below this threshold limit --:ern
spot or some portion of line after the spot appears. If the moveme.- : tra
the spot is fast, it appears as dim horizontal line or may be invis- - '.t of
In figure 17.23(b\ a sawtooth voltage waveform is shown, which -. ,,,: - : tloni
one. In
idealNo.
Page 315this waveform retrace time is zero. But in practice it .= -
of 328. .1av1r
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
l
This blanking voltage is
usually triggered by time base generator.
ria
17.8.12. Caliberation Circuit
Normally an oscillator which generates a known and fixed voltage at
square waveform, with fixed frequency is provided in the CRO.
ate
voltage, current, frequency and phase angle of any signal.
17.9.1. Measurement of Phase Difference
when two sinusoidal signal of equal frequency having some phase
difference is applied to the deflection plates of cRo, a straight line or an
ellipse appears on the screen. In the case of a straight line appearing on
the screen, phase angle difference would be 1g0" or 0.. But in casl of
an ellipse we will have to use a formula for determination of phase
difference.
The phase difference Q can be determined by the graphical
yM
representation of two sinusoidal wave with the output shown in
lrgure 17.25 as an ellipse. The phase difference is measured by measuring
du and Du of the ellipse and can be calculated as follows:
d.
phaseangle6=:^u
- lJu
I
ud
Fig. 11.25.
17.9.2. Measurement of Frequency of a Voltage Signal
St
The various pattern like circle, ellipse, figure of eight etc. obtained
':r cRo are known as Lissajous patterns. A Lissajous pattern is a
attern which is stationary on the screen of a cRo. It means that the
;rot traces out the same pattern for every cycle of a voltage signal. The
-atio of frequencies of vertical
and horizontal voltagesignils should be
. rational or fractional number to have steady pattern. 5o the condition
rPage No. a Lissajous
having pattern on the screen ts
316 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
faA I
f*B v
where A and B are integers S
l
Lissajous patterns are of two types. Fjrst one is closed Lissajous
pattern and has no free end. The second one is open Lissajous pattern
ria
p
and has free ends. Both types are shown in figure 77.26. flr
In a Lissajous pattern ratio of frequency of vertical signal to the al
frequency of horizontal signal is equal to the ratio of positive Y peaks to
positive X peaks in that Pattern 1i
^.fa
5O,t- 1.
Jx
Thus, by counting the positive Y-peaks and X-peaks on a
ate
Lissajous pattern, ratio of frequencies of two voltage signals can be
determined.
\
I
,t
yM
any electrical signal as the deflection of the electrostatic beam is direcc--' 17.2
proportional to the deflection plate voltage. 1a )
For measurement of direct voltage, firstly the spot is centered on ti-rt 17.4.
screen without applying any voltage signal to the deflection plates. The: 17.5.
d.irect voltage to be measured is applied between a pair of deflectii:
plates and deflection of the spot is observed on the screen. The magniru,fu
of deflection multiplied by the deflection factor gives the value of dire"-
St
l
For measurement of current, the current under measurement is
ria
passed through a known non inductive resistance and the voltage drop
across non inductive resistance is usually amplified by a calibrated
amplifier.
SUMMARY
The operational and amplifier find an extensive use in the field of
instrumentation specially in biomedicai electronics. Other important
ate
device for finding out the value of output of the transducer are
different bridges.
The cathode ray oscilloscope in a versatile eiectronic instrument
which in very useful for research and development as well as in
repair of all biomedical instruments. The cathode ray oscilloscope in
particular useful in the measurement of frequency, voltage current.
It can show the resultant effect of various waveshapes. The working
principle of analogue type cathoCe ray oscilloscope with the help of
detailed block diagram is explaineo in this chapter. The working and
construction of cathode ray tube is also explained. The different
yM
fluorescent materials are quoted on the cathode ray tube. The coating
of zinc orthosilicate gives a green trace which is very suitable for
visual observation. The coating of calciu5 tungstate gives a blue and
ultra.riolet radiation which is very suitabl'Cfor photographic recording.
The coating of zinc sulphide with other materials giving a white light
suitable for TV.
C
(t& ercded
diagram.
L7.2. Draw the pin diagram of an op-amp IC 747.
17.3. Draw the general block diagram of CRO and explain.
17.4. E.xplain with block diagram the various part of a CRT.
17.5. Write short notes on the following:
(r) Cathode ray tube
(il) Electrostatic focussing
(iil) Measurement of phase angle and frequency by a CRO
St
e-
aaa
oltr
l
(
ria
l
.\
Practicals in Biomedica!
ate
lnstrumentation
:s. fnside this chapter
1.1. Background
r.2. Development
1.3. Specihcation of Requirement
1.4. Man Instrumentation
yM
1.5. Problems Encountered in Measuring a Living System
1.6. Anatomy and Physiological
t.7 Summary
.
(c) Ventilator
(@ Incubator
(e) Boyle's Apparatus
(fl Pulse O>rymeter
18.'1.1 B.P. Apparatus
I
(z) Sphygmomanometer.
(izJ Stethoscope
,ui|
(b) Principle
The wall mounted Sphygmomanometer is shown in ligure 18.1 Tht
broncial artery in the hand is blocked by applying pressure higher tha:
320
Page No. 319 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Practical in Biomedical lnstrumentation 3?.1
systolic pressure. The pressure in the cuff is released slowly and when
the arterial pressure exeeds the pressure in the cuff the blood will start
flowing. When the opening in the brachial artery is very small a turbul:nce
is generated in the blood. This turbulence korotkoff sounds generated
l
can be heard in stetloscope and the pressure by seeing the position of
mercury in sphygmometer is noted. The pressure is further reduced and
ria
when normal sound is heard the blood pressure is again measured.
(c) Procedure
(zJ The cuff is wrapped on the left hand as shown in figure 18.1.
(ii) The cuff is inflated by applying pressure with the help of rubber
bulb which work as a hand pressure pump. Before applying pressure
the release valve is opened.
(iiz) The cuff is inflated at least 40 mm of mercury more than the
ate
normal systolic pressure. The normal value is 120 to 150. The cuff
is inflated upto 2OO mm of mercury.
(iu) After the pressure reaches 200 mm of Hg the release valve is
closed.
(u) There will not beany sound heard in the stateloscope.
(u'i) Slowly open the release valve and listen to the sound in the
stetloscope. When a gusting sound (due to flow of blood from a
small opening) in heard, close the release value and note down the
reading from the mercury manometer. This reading shall be systolic
yM
blood pressure.
Mercury
manometer
ud
Stethoscope placed
at the elbow over the
branchial arteries
blood pressure.
(uiiz) The blood pressure is taken 3 times and average value is the blood
pressure. This is written as systollic blood pressure/Diastollic blood
pressure. The normal value is 120/80 mm of Hg.
l
selection switch.
ria
(14 Patient Cable.
(ii]4 Chart paper jelly tube, electrode clips for limbs and suction cup
electrodes for chest.
(b) Procedure
(zJ The patient is asked to remove shoes and clothes. Patient is asked
to wear cotton gown which has opening from the front side. Patient
is asked to lie on the wooden table.
ate
(ii) Jelly is applied in small dots at the place of contact on the links 18.1
and chest positions V, to Vu.
(o'l,
(iii) The colours of the leads I to III are used to connect the electrodes
to the hands, feet. The chest leads are connected. (i,
(iu) The ECG machine is switched ON. The caliberation button is pressed, (il)
I
so that the chart paper moves and shows the 1 mv pulse standard. lbl r
il This is necessary to check the machine constancy of the pulse and
t I,
,,
amplitude. sun
j (u) The lead selection switch is set to lead I position and the ECG level
pattern is traced on the graph paper. Take 3 or 4 readings.
yM
:hrou
(ui) The lead selector switch is set lead II and lead III. lhe r
(uii) The selection switch is set for recording from auxiliary leads VR.
(c) Pr
aVL, aVF.
(uiizJ Connect the selector switch to V leads and obtain 6 records for V- o
to Vu.
(ii)
(c) Study of result
Observe the QRS complex of each of the 12 leads and observe the
there is no broadening or notched QRS. 18.1.5
Bo
(al Apparatus
ibl Pri
(z) Ventilator
(ir) Mask Th
:,_-,dy p
(b) Principle r:- alf
The ventilator is a direct transmission type. In this the gas in directll r rich
delivered from the source of compressed gas to the patient throu-q:- r_-.'erse
mask. The system is shown in figure 18.2.
St
Usi
' :nou
(c)'Procedure
.:tent
The direct power transmission type of ventilator along with patie:--: ':5 ar
mask is studied.
= flov
:ltted
-- prel
Page No. 321 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
Practical in Biomedical lnstrumentation 323
Exhaust
,/
l
ria
Fig. 18.2. Dlrect power transmission type ventilator with patient
ate
18.1.4. lncubator
la) Apparatus
(r) Incubator
(iz') Thermometer
Principle
Incubators are useful for pre-mature new born babies who require
un light and are to be kept in constant temperature for proper
evelopment. The incubators are provided with the source of light and
yM
nrough a thermocouple ald heaters a constant temperative is maintained.
he chamber is a transparent chamber for proper observation.
Procedure
(z) Measure the temperature in the Incubator after putting oN the
instrument for some timer.
(lzJ The temperature is measured at an interval of 30 minutes for
3-4 times.
8.1.5. Boyle's Apparatus
Apparatus
ud
Body plethysmograph
Principle
The functional residual capacity (FRC) can be measured by using a
y plethysmograph given in figure 18.3. The body plethysmograph is
n air tight box in which the patient is asked to sit. The Boyle's law
hich states that at constant temperature the volume of gas varies
r,,ersely with the pressure is used.
Using this law the ratio off the change in lung volume to change
St
including the air in the lung of the patient is constant as the bos -s
airtight. When the patient exhale air from his lungs the bc:r lb
volume of patient in reduced and the pressure is reduced in the bcr-
AT
l
T}
ria
wl
th
ga
tal
usl
ac(
tim
ate
(cl
yM
T]
Fig. 18.3. Body plethysmograph using Boyle's apparatus ,::d t
Conversely when the patient inhales, his body volume increases t ialm
increases the pressure in the box. The functional residual capacitr' i
is measured with the shutter in the breathing tube closed. With nn
allowed to flow, the mouth pressure which is measured by a transc,
can be assumed to be equal to lung pressure. The patient is ask: Mt
ud
(b) Principle
The efficiency of pulmonary gas exchange, the blood gas transport
and tissue oxygenation can be known by noninvasive blood gas monitoring.
l
The normal technique to determine Llood gas is taking arterial blood
which are painful and give data which ls vata only for"the time when
ria
the sample is taken. The continuous monivasive monitoring of blood
gases alow the physician to recognize changes in tissue o>rygenation
and
take corrective action at the earliast.
Blood oxygen saturation is measured by finger pulse photo signal
using red and Intra Red light through finger putp. ftrrs does not give very
accurate result but gives the advantage of not taking arterial utooa
-"rry
times, which is painful and not practical in case oflritically ill patients.
ate
(c) Procedure
{:i"W
yM
Fig. 18.4. Handled Pulse Oximetery
The finger is placed on the sensor and the reading of So, in percentage
and the pulse per minute may be noted. from the oigitut'Handled pulse
oximeter shown in frgure 18.4.
18.2. EXPERIMENT 2
Measure the concentration of blood sugar in a Glucometer.
ud
Procedure
St
The fasting blood sample is tested after overnight fast. This is done
ly morning without taking anything.
The reagent strip is fitted in the Gluconate as shown in figure 1g.5.
The finger is pricked by a rancer on which needre is already fitted.
5-e finger is squeezed so that blood comes out
of the finger. The portion
:enPage No.has 324
blood come 328.is put near the Grucometer. lt is sucked by
ofout
t glucometer as soon as rt comes in contact with the reagent strip.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
1E
l
Inr
de
ria
(al
(bt
ate
Fig. 18.5. Glucameter (i1
(zJ Audiometer
(ir) Earphone .it I
(zii) Recorder driven by stepper motor'
ud
CJ
connected to the switch which is connected to the attenuator at
a continuous record of the patients intensity adjustmenr :h
audiogram chart. C}
(iu) The aud,iogram gives the response of the ears with rea :(
-":rt
frequency. This is irnportant in advising a patient to use -Re
of heaving aid.
Page No. 325 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
I
EXPERIMENT 4
Operate and. familiarize with defibrillator and bed side monitor. This
involves operation and study of the main features of differents type of
l
defrillators and bed side monitors.
ria
(a) Apparatus
(rJ Portable defrillator unit
(irJ Bed side monitor with different input transducers and leads.
(b) Procedure
Study and operate defibrillator :
(z) Study the dehbrillator as per type of discharge, i.e., d.c. defibrillator,
ate
dual peak d.c. def,rbrillator truncated. d.c. defibrillator.
(ii) Check whether defibrillator is provided with an ECG monitor.
(ifi) Check whether defibrillator is synchronised type. In synchronised
type, the application of the shock pulse of defibrillation is avoided
for 25-30 ms after the R ware, if exists.
(iu) Check whether the defibrillated is mains operated or only uses
power for charging internal batteries. If so remove main before
starting the operation of defrillator.
(u) Check the type of paddles. Check about the insulation provided on
the cables and paddles.
yM
(uz) Check about the push switches provided on the paddles.
(uii) Now charge the unit and connect the paddles on conducting foam
pad kept on a metal plate over on insulating table top. Observe the
discharge sound.
(uiir) Note how long it taken for the charge to build up again for applying
a second shock.
(rx) If the unit is battery operated, remove the mains connection and
use it from battery power. Observe how much battery voltage drops
after each shock is delivered.
(x) Note the time taken by the batteries to fully charge from the mains.
ud
cted at the proper place i.e. on hands, leg and chest after applying
the gel.
(iu) Check all the parameters are visible on the bed side monitor like
ECG, heart rate, temperatory blood pressure and pulse rate.
(u) Remove one of the transduces like pulse rate transducer. This
action should sound an alarm is the bed side monior.
Page No. 326 of 328.
Fundamentals of Biomedical Instrumentation
328 Fundamentals of Biomedical lnstrumentation
(ufi rf the heart rate is below 40 and above 150 the bed side monitor
should sound an alarm to check this connect a pulse generator ;
and vary the pulse from 30 to i6o. The alarm should souncl upto
a pulse of 4o pulse/mm and should not sound between 40 to 150
l
pulse minute. If should again sound if the pulse rate is more than 1g^6
150 pulse/mm.
ria
\
equil
T
Measurement of Leakage current with the help of Safety Anaryzer. rt PGi (
involves measurement of the leakage current in the chassis of the :qultr
biomedical equipment and patient leads.
o
(a) Apparatus GA
(iil
ate
(l) Digital Multimeter
(lz) A Capacitor (iu) -
(u) |
(b) Procedure tui) 1
The following procedure is employed for the measurement of leakage
current in the chaise of biomedical equipment
,-,ii) I
\
tll
:
iia F
l (z) connect the combination of resistance, capacitor which simulate
r-r) E
i
the heart as a function of frequency. The capacitor of 0.15 pF in
parallel with a resistance of 1k ohm on digital multimeter as shown -Y) U
.t
in figure 18.6. -.r) o
yM
(li) connect the electromedical equipment to power source (mains) and :l Lt
measure leakage without putting the power switch to oN position. -:1 Ar
(iir) Measure the leakage by putting the power switch to oN position. -:lIn
(lu) Do the same measurement by reversing the polarity i.e. connectins ,rAs
phase and neutral in the reverse direction. .r Ne
', Ht
Test point
Digital
ud
voltmeter Digital
voltmeter
(a) (b)
Fig. 18.6. (a) Principle of leakage current meter (b) measurement of
chassis leakage Gurrent using leakage meter
(u) The leakage current from the chassis should not exeeC 5OO m -\ r
St
(irJ The leakage currerrt in patient leads should not be more than
50 mA.
l
EXPERIMENT 6
ria
Visit to hospital for exposure of various medical electronic related
:quipment.
The student should be taken in group to sorrre leading hospitals like
?GI or any hospital of the Medical college. The main medical electronics
:quipment they must see include the following faciJities:
(0 C.A.T. (Computerised Axial Tomography) Scan
(r4 MRI (Magnetic Resonance Imaging)
ate
(iir) Ultrasound Machine with probes.
(iu) X-Ray Machine
(u) Stress Thalium Machine
(ut') Trade Mill Testing Machine.
uli) Echocardiography Machine
iirJ Electro Cardiograph
rx) Electro Encelephograph
(x) Ultrasonic Diathermy Machine
rz) Ophthalmoscope
yM
,:zi) LASOR Equipment for Ophthalmoscopy.
,rirJ Autoanalyzer for blood test.
,ru) Inclubator
,:u) Aspirator
:d Nebulizer
'izJ Humidifier.
aa]
ud
St